*** empty log message ***
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
CommitLineData
c67de8ba 1GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
31e0fbdd 2Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
3See the end for copying conditions.
4
5Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
3787e12e 6For older news, see the file ONEWS
5a2c89c3
JL
7You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
8`view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
a933dad1 9
ad8d610b
KS
10Temporary note:
11 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
12 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
13When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
1a0b9ae4 14so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
ad8d610b 15
05197f40 16\f
d278091b 17* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
76fb24bb 18
1ebd4f78
JB
19** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
20(Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
21the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
22setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
23
bc83b22b 24---
b687047c
WL
25** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
26 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
27 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
28 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
29 select the right one.
bc83b22b 30
0571f2d8 31** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
7bea57c9
DL
32when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
33provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
0571f2d8 34
2b6bb1f2 35---
d2a53bb7
PJ
36** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
37
4208da83
SM
38** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
39
2b6bb1f2 40---
76fb24bb
PJ
41** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
42`--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
43installed programs.
44
2b6bb1f2 45---
81f755ae 46** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
672ab90b
CW
47scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
48place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
49configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
50to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
5167cfda
CW
51to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
52in each user's home directory.
81f755ae 53
cd7d2d9e
EZ
54---
55** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
56You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
57Emacs with Leim.
58
4e5cdb4f
KS
59+++
60** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
61
62The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
63Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
64Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
65accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
66
67---
68** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
69the distribution.
70
71This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
72together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
73item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
74(Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
75
c60ee5e7
JB
76** Support for Cygwin was added.
77
a17b3614 78---
1096bcc0
GM
79** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
80
84913e36
EZ
81---
82** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
83
82e119fb
EZ
84---
85** Support for MacOS X was added.
86See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
87
2b6bb1f2 88---
3fa4ac47 89** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
16927a56 90
d2d70cb6 91---
4e5cdb4f
KS
92** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
93
94---
d7107586
SM
95** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
96types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
4e5cdb4f
KS
97
98\f
99* Changes in Emacs 21.4
d2d70cb6 100
1db7dd46
RS
101** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
102`calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
103character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
104boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
105`calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
56011a8c 106
414ac1a3 107** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
c44edf72 108
414ac1a3
RS
109Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
110click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
c44edf72 111click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
414ac1a3 112inside a link. With release 21.4, the behaviour of a Mouse-1 click
c44edf72
KS
113has been changed to match this context-sentitive dual behaviour.
114
414ac1a3
RS
115Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs may do much
116more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behaviour is only
c44edf72
KS
117activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
118(see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The lisp
119packages that are included in release 21.4 have been adapted to do
120this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
121is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
414ac1a3 122happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behaviour when you click
c44edf72
KS
123on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
124
414ac1a3
RS
125If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
126just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
127click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
c44edf72
KS
128you release it).
129
414ac1a3 130Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
c44edf72
KS
131drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
132
414ac1a3 133You can customize the new Mouse-1 behaviour via the new user option
c44edf72
KS
134`mouse-1-click-follows-link'.
135
1db7dd46
RS
136+++
137** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
138
139`visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
140when visiting the file.
141
142`visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
143needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
144when saving the file.
145
146+++
147** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
148major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
149designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
150sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
151So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
152modes do.
153
414ac1a3
RS
154+++
155** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
156(beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs asks you whether to
157discard it or keep it.
158
18819b0f
RS
159** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
160
4ac3afb9
EZ
161** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
162of the file that precede the first header line.
163
5086e75d
LT
164+++
165** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
166by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
167and `C-c C-r'.
168
4d894c98
RS
169+++
170** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
171suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
172
7d01236c 173+++
61b73aa4
LT
174** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
175in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
176
2ee3b79e
RS
177** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
178
dd0a3ea3
LT
179+++
180** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
181for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
182non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
183specified by the syntax table.
184
8758f42e
JB
185** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
186You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
187existing values. For example:
188
189 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
190
191will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
192irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
193
3fc3e0a6
JL
194** New features in evaluation commands
195
a1bcf785 196+++
3fc3e0a6
JL
197*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
198the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
199
200*** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
201in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
202by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
203function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
204`eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
a7ab1711 205
9254ee5e
KH
206** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
207characters.
208
64a0fd20
KH
209** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
210in the current input method to input a character at point.
44251fad 211
f0529fe1
JB
212** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
213(prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
214
215** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
216C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
217
11d7bca4 218** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
85f6be54 219arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
bfd40f00
JB
220default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
221`help-default-arg-highlight'.
f0529fe1 222
21fb7588 223---
0dbc1dd0
LT
224** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
225option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
226except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
227controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
8248b4ad
LT
228overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
229
230The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
231support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
232
233`comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
d1b2b8cc 234read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
8248b4ad
LT
235lines, including any prompts.
236
237`comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
238read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
239part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
240and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
241not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
0dbc1dd0
LT
242`kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
243kill-ring, but does not delete it.
21fb7588 244
d88beab5
KS
245** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
246the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
247
d1b2b8cc 248** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
879054ea 249
c78bf503 250+++
a27ddfaf
KS
251** New command line option -Q.
252
253This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
254the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
255cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
256
f8f853de
SM
257** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
258variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
259
4ba2fd66
LT
260** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
261before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
262supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
263
264** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
265If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
266mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
d1b2b8cc 267displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
4ba2fd66 268the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
d1b2b8cc 269just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
4ba2fd66
LT
270rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
271be mode dependent.
272
9f14953b
LT
273If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
274then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
275mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
276toggles this mode.
277
428b6b85
LT
278** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
279other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
280revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
281and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
d1b2b8cc 282mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
428b6b85
LT
283`revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
284decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
285that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
286work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
287
288** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
289Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
290control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
291which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
292only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
293
294** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
295buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
296mode.
297
d3a29dd8
DP
298** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
299
300Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
301recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
302red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
303(controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
304
e5c644da
DP
305Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
306This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
307This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
308
d3a29dd8
DP
309The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
310you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
311leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
312`compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
313that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
ecf4207f
SM
314
315The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
316
2a075e37
JL
317** Compilation mode enhancements:
318
4d894c98 319+++
2a075e37
JL
320*** New user option `compilation-environment'.
321This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
322compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
323subprocesses inherit.
324
325** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
326
327*** There's a new separate package grep.el.
328
329*** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
ecf4207f
SM
330
331Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
d1b2b8cc 332can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
ecf4207f 333
2a075e37
JL
334*** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
335
336*** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
337`grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
338compilation mode settings for grep commands.
339
340*** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
341buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
342--color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
343match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
344buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
345source line is highlighted.
346
347*** New key bindings in grep output window:
348SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
349previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
350the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
351other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
352previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
353file.
354
355** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
356specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
357in new face `next-error'.
358
2a223f35
EZ
359** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
360compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
361modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
362buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
363matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
364C-c C-f.
f5e9cb97 365
ecf4207f
SM
366** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
367
ee213e98
JL
368** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
369resync points in both windows.
370
2f9da07b
EZ
371** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
372This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
373the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
374using strokes as an input method.
375
23f87bed
MB
376** Gnus package
377
378*** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
379Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
380PGP/MIME.
381
382*** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
383See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
384
61d244ca
LH
385+++
386** Desktop package
387
388*** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
389desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
390saving.
391
392*** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
393buffer list.
394
395*** New commands:
396 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
397 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
398 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
399 it was loaded.
400
401*** New customizable variables:
402 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
403 killed.
404 - desktop-file-name-format.
405 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
406 - desktop-locals-to-save.
407 - desktop-globals-to-clear.
408 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp.
409
410*** New command line option --no-desktop
411
412*** New hooks:
413 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
414 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
415
b1faee6e
EZ
416---
417** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
418When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
419include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
420Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
421to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
422and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
423feature.
424
61042632
SM
425** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
426
427 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
428 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
429 % emacsclient -s foo file1
430 % emacsclient -s bar file2
431
ed2846bd 432+++
dcf0c8e0
KS
433** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
434(not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
435two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
436Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
437cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
438
439The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
440revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
441
ed2846bd 442+++
b2b681f1
KS
443** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
444now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
445down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
446right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
dcf0c8e0
KS
447
448This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
b2b681f1
KS
449`indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
450this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
451
452If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
f2a54fbc 453displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
b2b681f1 454
f2a54fbc
KS
455Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
456of each bitmap individually.
b2b681f1 457
f2a54fbc
KS
458For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
459in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
460arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
461left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
dcf0c8e0 462
d18473b9
LT
463** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
464in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
465same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
466`help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
467keyboard oriented alternative.
468
469** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
470automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
471point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
472determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
473to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
474
475** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
476move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
477non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
478echo area, using `display-local-help'.
479
e5dadca7
LT
480+++
481** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
482preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
483hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
3f70fe82
LT
484preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
485hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
486enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
487anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
e5dadca7 488
cff5e534
SM
489** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
490On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
491
8fe7d8c8
RS
492+++
493** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
f8977ff3 494now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
8fe7d8c8
RS
495an interactively callable function.
496
497
668c2ab0
JB
498** sql changes.
499
500*** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
501SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
502buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
503session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
504SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
505
506The following values are supported:
507
508 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
509 db2 DB2
510 informix Informix
511 ingres Ingres
512 interbase Interbase
513 linter Linter
514 ms Microsoft
515 mysql MySQL
516 oracle Oracle
517 postgres Postgres
518 solid Solid
519 sqlite SQLite
520 sybase Sybase
521
522The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
523SQL mode indicator.
524
525The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
526your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
527`sql-product' to accomplish this.
528
2c2cd44f
SM
529ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
530
668c2ab0
JB
531*** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
532font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
533all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
534you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
535
536 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2c2cd44f 537 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
668c2ab0
JB
538
539*** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
540SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
541highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
542
543*** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
544Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
545sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
e4aaf69c 546osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
668c2ab0
JB
547are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
548terminated.
549
550If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
551called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
552credentials to authenticate the user.
553
2c2cd44f
SM
554*** Postgres support is enhanced.
555Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
556the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
557
558*** MySQL support is enhanced.
559Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
560
668c2ab0
JB
561*** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
562packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
563defaults.
564
565*** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
566appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
567`sql-product'.
568
80384936
RS
569** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
570with special modes such as Tar mode.
571
ee216b2c
KS
572** Enhancements to apropos commands:
573
d1b2b8cc 574*** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
ee216b2c
KS
575When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
576be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
577available.
578
579*** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
580to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
581number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
582regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
583match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
584matching item.
800bebe3 585
c6de56a0
RS
586+++
587** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
588since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
589the operating system or your X server.
590
591** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
d60f1316 592When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
668c2ab0 593restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
d60f1316
LT
594
595** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
596By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
597
a1bcf785
JL
598** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
599`insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
600
601** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
602list starting after point.
603
ee213e98
JL
604** Dired mode:
605
606*** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
607dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
608introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
609
a1bcf785
JL
610*** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
611with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
612
613+++
614*** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
615of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
ee213e98
JL
616
617+++
618*** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
619control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
620by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
621too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
622doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
623special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
624
625+++
626*** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
627types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
628what external viewers to use and when.
629
630*** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
a1bcf785 631into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
ee213e98 632
61d244ca
LH
633+++
634** Dired-x:
635
636*** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
637command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
638marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
639mode toggling function instead.
640
8ab314f9
JL
641+++
642** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
643when the file name contains wildcard characters.
644
645+++
646** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
647when the file name contains wildcard characters.
648
649** FFAP
650
651+++
652*** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
653C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
654C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
655C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
656
657---
658*** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
659it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
660multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
661
43ea9947 662** Info mode:
a1bcf785
JL
663
664*** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
665with the number appended to the *info* buffer name.
666
0dfddff5
JL
667*** Regexp isearch (C-M-s and C-M-r) can search through multiple nodes.
668Failed isearch wraps to the top/final node.
669
670*** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
671`Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
672search without prompting for a new search string.
673
a1bcf785
JL
674*** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
675
676*** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
677from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
678
679*** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
680Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
681possible matches.
682
683*** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
684the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
685arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
686
a1bcf785
JL
687*** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
688and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
689
690*** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
691references and following them calls `browse-url'.
692
d60f1316 693+++
43ea9947 694*** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
d60f1316
LT
695If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
696`Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
697
7dcac3a6
JL
698*** Images in Info pages are supported.
699Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
700Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
701version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
702
ee213e98
JL
703+++
704*** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
705
706---
707*** Info-index offers completion.
708
5d0ab731
JB
709** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
710'sql-sqlite'.
711
bf078377 712** BibTeX mode:
d528bff7 713*** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
e0dc0c55
SM
714point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
715
c20052b2
SM
716*** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
717an existing BibTeX entry.
e0dc0c55 718
bf078377 719*** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
e0dc0c55 720
bf078377
SM
721*** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
722`crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
e0dc0c55
SM
723for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
724scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
a6aa9850
KG
725automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
726bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
727
728*** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
729use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
730
731*** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
732automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
733
734*** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
735types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
736
737*** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
738point according to context (bound to M-tab).
739
740*** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
02c8032e
SM
741locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
742Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
a6aa9850
KG
743
744*** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
745individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
bf078377 746
02c8032e
SM
747*** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
748of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
e0dc0c55 749
02c8032e 750*** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
e0dc0c55
SM
751in multiple BibTeX files.
752
753*** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
754of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
755
6f8968c8
KS
756** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
757displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
758at the edges of the window.
759
bd9b2b20 760** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
6f8968c8
KS
761in addition to the individual display margin settings.
762
763Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
bd9b2b20 764horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
6f8968c8
KS
765or when the frame is resized.
766
fbe57420
KS
767** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
768
769These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
fd940504 770horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
fbe57420 771
0074d3a0
JD
772---
773** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
774 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
775 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
776
2a89019f
SM
777** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
778
c67de8ba
DL
779** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
780speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
781
42f81f64
KS
782If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
783XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
784
a95cefd7 785** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
c64a682c
SM
786
787** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
788`file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
789
790** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
d1b2b8cc 791Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
c64a682c 792
347003be
DL
793** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
794
556621f6
NR
795** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
796and other common debugger commands.
797
1d1d1b1f
JB
798** recentf changes.
799
800The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
801enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
802automatic cleanup.
803
804With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
805specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
806example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
807recent list with different symbolic links.
808
809To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
810and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
811misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
812`recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
813aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
814
4cdf4bde
DL
815** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
816from the locale.
61cb0b53 817
5ab0ceed
RS
818** Init file changes
819
820You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
821~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
822
0ec6b206
SM
823** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
824
ff6a3bfb
RS
825** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
826 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
827 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
828 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
829 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
830 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
831
a1b4049d
BW
832** MH-E changes.
833
eccf9613 834Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
a1b4049d
BW
835version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
836
5b8b9fa7 837+++
175573ac
DL
838** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
839`--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
840expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
841
842** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
5b8b9fa7 843
f5d0cc77
RS
844+++
845** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
846When the file is maintained under version control, that information
847appears between the position information and the major mode.
2c37653c 848
957e7c38
RS
849** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
850against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
851
2e4e635a
RS
852+++
853** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
854for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
855top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
856control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
857set-fringe-style.
555c87d8 858
2e4e635a 859+++
d7b590b1
MR
860** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
861to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
862directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
863"~/".
864
2b6bb1f2 865+++
af7272b1
RS
866** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
867read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
d1b2b8cc
RS
868want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
869file.)
af7272b1 870
cc305a60
RS
871** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
872revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
873
8798ecdb
KH
874** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
875of a file.
876
dacec596 877---
4cdf4bde 878** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
dacec596
EZ
879
880Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
881ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
882See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
883
b03763f4
EZ
884---
885** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
886`buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
887in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
888
889`buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
890leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
d1b2b8cc 891If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
b03763f4
EZ
892shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
893and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
894
895`buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
896the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
897t, and the status is shown.
898
899Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
900the Buffers menu is regenerated.
901
2e4e635a 902+++
4d3eda1c 903** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
2e4e635a
RS
904now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
905specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
906faces.
4d3eda1c 907
b51dcd14 908** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
175573ac 909Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
4cdf4bde
DL
910Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
911Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
912automatically according to the locale.)
175573ac
DL
913
914** Indian support has been updated.
915The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
916assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
4cdf4bde
DL
917Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
918supported.
fc2938d1 919
813f3d41 920---
fc2938d1
DL
921** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
922ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
923vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
924latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
4cdf4bde
DL
925bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
926tamil-inscript.
fc2938d1 927
813f3d41
RS
928---
929** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
930in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
931Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
932
933---
fc2938d1
DL
934** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
935library. These include complete versions of most of those in
30955b19
EZ
936codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
937obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
938and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
939latter is used by GNU locales.
fc2938d1 940
347003be 941** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
66189a40
KH
942By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
943single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
944turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
945sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
946system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
947interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
347003be
DL
948You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
949`ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
950coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
742f8710 951one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
347003be 952The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
a4ac5b17 953
af3b9e47
KH
954** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
955Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
956
a4ac5b17
DL
957** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
958characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
959fontset appropriately.
fc2938d1
DL
960
961** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
a4ac5b17 962unicode.
fc2938d1 963
1c6576ab 964+++
a4ac5b17
DL
965** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
966Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
967the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
968Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
969sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
970translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
971mule-unicode-... ones.
972
d1b2b8cc 973By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
a4ac5b17
DL
974Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
975with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
976possible.
fc2938d1
DL
977
978You can force a more complete unification with the user option
979unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
980into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
a4ac5b17
DL
981mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
982will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
fc2938d1
DL
983
984** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
985either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
986when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
e9b9ec8b 987controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
8f9891ab 988
7443bd8e
KH
989** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
990coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
991(Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
992command.
993
2a1e884e 994---
2e4e635a 995** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
5a597a71
SM
996On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
997amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
998
ecb3b438
JD
999---
1000** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
fb40303e 1001be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
ecb3b438
JD
1002
1003---
fb40303e
JD
1004** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
1005ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
1006
e2a57f28
JD
1007---
1008** Dialogs and menus pop down when pressing C-g.
1009
fb40303e
JD
1010---
1011** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
1012and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
1013to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
ecb3b438 1014
1394f7f5 1015+++
fb40303e 1016** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
1394f7f5
JD
1017disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
1018
cba71f24
JD
1019+++
1020** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
3a0ab7ec 1021by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
cba71f24
JD
1022the new dialog.
1023
267bdad3
EZ
1024+++
1025** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
1026The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
1027default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
1028cursor does.
1029
23706d6c
KS
1030+++
1031** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
1032now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
1033
c0e48b0b
RS
1034** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1035various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1036program files that include other program files.
1037
1038Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1039all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1040in them.
1041
172f1af1
EZ
1042---
1043** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1044when Emacs visits them.
1045
2a1e884e 1046---
ded0c207
EZ
1047** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
1048
1049`mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
1050default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
1051automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
1052
b5d2c621
KH
1053** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1054requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1055Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1056and use the more appropriately result.
1057
63a4cd16
EZ
1058+++
1059** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
63a7fdcf
EZ
1060The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
1061the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
1062will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
1a667242 1063
63a7fdcf 1064The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
d1b2b8cc 1065hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
63a7fdcf
EZ
1066window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
1067window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
1068many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
1069gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
1070
813f3d41
RS
1071The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
1072`auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
1073
bf078377 1074** TeX modes:
a95cefd7 1075*** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2a1e884e 1076+++
0ec6b206 1077*** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
63bfbe6f
RS
1078by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1079command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1080TeX commands to use at startup.
0ec6b206
SM
1081*** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1082and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
63bfbe6f 1083
c64a682c
SM
1084*** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1085
2a1e884e 1086+++
b0ada147
RS
1087** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1088to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1089mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1090different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1091be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1092feature is not enabled.
3996d07a 1093
62ce3608
KS
1094** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1095select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1096normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1097the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
fa7f39ad 1098window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
62ce3608
KS
1099to give it focus.
1100
1c6576ab
RS
1101+++
1102** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1103description various information about a character, including its
d6696bb6
KH
1104encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1105widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1106clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
c145bbb3 1107
81f755ae
CW
1108+++
1109** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1110search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1111`multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1112buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1113rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1114
1791907b
DK
1115** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1116been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1117in Indented-Text mode.
1118
1119** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1120`query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1121a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1122
1123** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1124`replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1125where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1126time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
59035302
JL
1127`query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1128to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1129All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1130replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1131can be edited for each replacement.
1791907b 1132
a31a30b5
JL
1133** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
1134`query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
1135
1136** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
1137`query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
836c086b 1138
255ec1b0 1139+++
b2bd7aff
RS
1140** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1141is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1142can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1143mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1144also disable mouse highlighting.
90e87070 1145
26fb226b
KS
1146** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1147shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1148variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1149
2a1e884e 1150+++
fd42af9d
SM
1151** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1152an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1153font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1154if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1155trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1156
236f1c76
EZ
1157+++
1158** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1159Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1160variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1161prompt string.
1162
9a770d8d 1163+++
fd4f8b36
KS
1164** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1165of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1166the mode line of the currently selected window.
1167
89f8199f
KS
1168The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1169the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1170
2e4e635a 1171---
1f600b1b 1172** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
2e4e635a
RS
1173This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1174as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1175You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1176it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1177current date and time, current line and column number in the
1178mode-line.
1f600b1b 1179
2e4e635a 1180---
a9c6d330
PA
1181** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1182
2a1e884e 1183+++
347003be 1184** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2a1e884e 1185in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
7c961dc2 1186`display-time-mail-directory'.
2d4ef682 1187
a4fc6fc9
PJ
1188---
1189** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1190
e58d8457 1191+++
5e101746 1192** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
e58d8457 1193M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
5e101746
RS
1194argument it toggles the mode.
1195
1196Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1197that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1198
2e4e635a 1199+++
b54cfb55
CW
1200** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1201arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1202disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1203`inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1204`inhibit-splash-screen').
1205
7cc8f35a
EZ
1206** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1207
e0c124ce 1208+++
7cc8f35a 1209*** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
e0c124ce
EZ
1210mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1211terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1212database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1213set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1214terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1215when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1216in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1217user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1218
7cc8f35a
EZ
1219---
1220*** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1221than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1222256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1223the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1224all of these colors.
1225
11a365f9
EZ
1226+++
1227*** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1228faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1229256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
123088-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1231colors as on X.
1232
7cc8f35a
EZ
1233---
1234*** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1235
6625fc7d
EZ
1236+++
1237** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1238
1239When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1240`--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1241whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
616d7a51 1242screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
6625fc7d 1243
2b6bb1f2 1244---
a8f57660 1245** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2b6bb1f2 1246automatically.
cb8d4d07 1247
2b6bb1f2 1248+++
eaffd16d 1249** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
4e3dd7cf
MB
1250modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1251like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1252otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1253
2b6bb1f2 1254+++
00b1ee61
RS
1255** Changes in C-h bindings:
1256
1257C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1258
1259C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1260 that do not change:
1261
1262C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1263C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1264
1265The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1266have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1267
93607efd
KS
1268C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1269
1270- C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1271 run by the key sequence.
1272
1273- C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1274 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1275 that command.
1276
1277For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
bf8dd4e3 1278to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
93607efd
KS
1279
1280- C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1281 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1282
1283- C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1284 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1285
1286- C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1287 new-kill-line is on C-k
1288
e42d6474
EZ
1289+++
1290** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1291To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1292`isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1293constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1294for details.
1295
2b6bb1f2 1296+++
a207b33c
RS
1297** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1298making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1299command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1300bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1301
e42d6474
EZ
1302+++
1303** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1304at the end of a line.
1305
59035302
JL
1306+++
1307** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1308Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1309and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1310
1311+++
dc29ba9b
JL
1312** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1313`query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1314search string used as the string to replace.
59035302 1315
2a075e37 1316+++
662b102f
KS
1317** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1318history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1319user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
2a075e37
JL
1320
1321+++
1322** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1323If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1324elements are deleted.
1325
2b6bb1f2 1326+++
d9f7eb77
RS
1327** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1328be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1329`yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1330of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1331
1c6576ab 1332+++
b54cfb55
CW
1333** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1334M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1335`Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1336remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1337
1c6576ab 1338+++
4e3dd7cf 1339** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
d1b2b8cc
RS
1340by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1341detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
4e3dd7cf
MB
1342When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1343unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1344command lines to be used than was possible before.
1345
1c6576ab 1346---
4e3dd7cf
MB
1347** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1348In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1349check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1350for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1351sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1352its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1353case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1354
3116d142 1355+++
c721078e
RS
1356** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1357the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1358You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1359under the "[State]" button.
1360
63db1bb3
MR
1361** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1362point (no integers are allowed).
1363
2b6bb1f2
RS
1364+++
1365** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
4febb0e7
RS
1366counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1367
2b6bb1f2 1368---
ca64d378 1369** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
a1e3dda0
RS
1370
1371*** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1372 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1373 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1374 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1375 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1376
1377*** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1378 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1379 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1380 (gud-finish).
1381
1382*** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1383 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1384
1385*** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1386 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1387 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1388
1389 Added Customization Variables
1390
1391*** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1392
1393*** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1394 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1395 java sources (previous method).
1396
1397*** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1398 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1399 is nil).
1400
1401 Minor Improvements
1402
9e94e254
SJ
1403*** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1404instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
d1b2b8cc 1405compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
9e94e254
SJ
1406`starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1407"starttls" tool).
1408
a1e3dda0
RS
1409*** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1410
1c6576ab 1411+++
43a88bc1
SM
1412** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1413to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
d29bf2fa 1414changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
43a88bc1 1415
1c6576ab 1416+++
111ed14e
SM
1417** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1418the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1419Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1420is only rarely needed.
1421
1c6576ab 1422---
cce5462e
SM
1423** JIT-lock changes
1424*** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
8ea55f33
EZ
1425
1426If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
fbe51115 1427idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
8ea55f33
EZ
1428example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1429only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
f67cc62e 1430
cce5462e
SM
1431*** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1432
1433jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1434jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1435refontification takes place.
1436
cad113ae
KG
1437+++
1438** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1439you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
d1b2b8cc
RS
1440C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1441you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1442This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
6a2067b2
JL
1443a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
1444Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
1445one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
1446active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
6710ea06 1447
2b6bb1f2 1448+++
18f10eda
RS
1449** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1450mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1451region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1452want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
2b6bb1f2
RS
1453ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1454command only.
18f10eda 1455
2b6bb1f2
RS
1456One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1457and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1458This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1459mark or the region.
32f665fa 1460
2b6bb1f2
RS
1461After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1462deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1463that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1464C-g.
66aa61d8 1465
2b6bb1f2 1466+++
66aa61d8 1467** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
d1b2b8cc 1468previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
66aa61d8
KS
1469mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1470
6a2067b2 1471** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
a31a30b5
JL
1472`beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
1473is already active in Transient Mark mode.
6a2067b2 1474
1c6576ab 1475+++
a474d59c
RS
1476** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1477C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1478switching to it.
7c425d82 1479
1c6576ab 1480+++
7c425d82
RS
1481** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1482all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1483affects the initial frame.
1484
efe459e4 1485+++
fbe51115
PJ
1486** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1487With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
564b1f76
EZ
1488if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1489paragraphs.
efe459e4 1490
1c6576ab 1491+++
b04dcf45
RS
1492** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1493have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1494directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1495directory listing into a buffer.
1496
1c6576ab 1497---
6710ea06
SM
1498** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1499(rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1500
cc563ece
KS
1501** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1502wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1503This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1504mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1505
2b6bb1f2 1506+++
457c233a
DL
1507** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1508current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1509may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1510characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1511emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1512keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1513or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1514by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
16927a56 1515
3aa2f38a
RS
1516+++
1517** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
273a3930
EZ
1518automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1519modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1520can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
2bc8d7c8 1521according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
3aa2f38a 1522
1c6576ab 1523+++
830047fd
RS
1524** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1525of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1526appears in.
6c0b2643 1527
d5ec54b6
KS
1528** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1529of the recognized cursor types.
c60ee5e7 1530
1c6576ab 1531---
758bf24f
GM
1532** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1533controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1534attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1535
1698fb36
GM
1536+++
1537** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1538convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1539
f5d0cc77
RS
1540+++
1541** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1542Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
eca7b908 1543`diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
f5d0cc77
RS
1544which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1545how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1546single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1547day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1548face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1549appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1550
33d0b73f
GM
1551+++
1552** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1553year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1554count backward from the end of the year.
1555
554b59cd
GM
1556+++
1557** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1558prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1559day of that ISO week.
1560
988c3fe3 1561---
97f3be50 1562** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
94f1c41a
GM
1563optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
1564rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
1565`christian-holidays' simpler.
97f3be50 1566
b9e6b498
GM
1567** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1568This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1569and `diary-header-line-format'.
1570
0fbe422d
GM
1571+++
1572** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1573the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1574`appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1575appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1576
d71d20ea
GM
1577** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1578and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1579from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1580`diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1581formats.
1582
1583
3f270c8a
AS
1584** VC Changes
1585
fc08c987
AS
1586*** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1587the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1588change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1589with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1590can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1591
1592 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1593
1594The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1595
1c6576ab 1596+++
3f270c8a
AS
1597*** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1598you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1599by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1600means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1601allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1602CVS.
1603
c64a682c
SM
1604*** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1605
eb766f96
MK
1606** EDiff changes.
1607
16757dcf 1608+++
eb766f96
MK
1609*** When comparing directories.
1610Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1611directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1612from one directory to another.
1613
16757dcf 1614+++
eb766f96
MK
1615*** When comparing files or buffers.
1616Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1617currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1618then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1619comparison.
1620
5d9c22fd 1621*** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
813f3d41
RS
1622backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1623`ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1624
ca8f3642 1625+++
e94a3679
FP
1626** Etags changes.
1627
73639417
FP
1628*** New regular expressions features
1629
1630**** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
df3eebcb
FP
1631The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1632only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1633--regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1634where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1635more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
6861f0e3
FP
1636(single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1637expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1638(which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1639span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1640and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1641
2c37653c 1642**** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
6861f0e3
FP
1643The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1644respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1645CR, TAB, VT,
1646
2c37653c 1647**** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
df3eebcb
FP
1648The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1649only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1650particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1651
2c37653c 1652**** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
df3eebcb
FP
1653The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1654per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1655
73639417
FP
1656*** New language parsing features
1657
d9256ccb
FP
1658**** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1659Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1660
5dc59f2e
FP
1661**** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1662
dfcb9727
FP
1663**** New language HTML.
1664Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1665used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1666
1667**** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1668If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1669size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1670
5dc59f2e
FP
1671**** New language Lua.
1672All functions are tagged.
dfcb9727 1673
73639417 1674**** In Perl, packages are tags.
81d66c62
FP
1675Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1676as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1677package::sub.
1678
dfcb9727
FP
1679**** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1680
2c37653c
FP
1681**** New language PHP.
1682Tags are functions, classes and defines.
5dc59f2e 1683If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
f175bfff 1684
73639417 1685**** New default keywords for TeX.
a0bbc0c5
FP
1686The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1687renewenvironment.
1688
81d66c62
FP
1689*** Honour #line directives.
1690When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1691directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1692specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1693created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1694writes tags pointing to the source file.
bf8dd4e3 1695
2c37653c 1696*** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
a0bbc0c5 1697This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
5cc4f104 1698be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
dfcb9727 1699reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
a0bbc0c5 1700the file FILE.
06ee6fcd 1701
c30567b7 1702+++
b5a67081
MS
1703** CC Mode changes.
1704
1705*** Font lock support.
1706CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1707supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1708package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1709locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1710AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1711different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1712
1713The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1714dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1715strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1716declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1717lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1718the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1719demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1720therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1721variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1722
1723Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1724fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1725with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1726(e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1727mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1728take the better part of a minute.
1729
1730**** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1731are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1732be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1733locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1734properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1735not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1736
1737**** Support for documentation comments.
1738There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1739Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1740language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1741buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1742
1743Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1744and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1745list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1746is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1747
1748**** Better handling of C++ templates.
1749As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1750now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1751given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1752parens.
1753
1754This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1755work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1756template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1757recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1758not as configurable as it ought to be.
1759
1760**** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1761Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1762The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1763All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1764handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1765
1766*** Support for the AWK language.
1767Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1768based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1769any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1770Here is a summary:
1771
1772**** Indentation Engine
1773The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1774
1775AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1776which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1777placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1778are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1779definition, or structured statement.
1780
1781The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1782mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1783any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1784
1785The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1786though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1787fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1788C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1789
1790**** Font Locking
1791There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1792three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1793idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1794the AWK language itself.
1795
1796**** Comment Commands
1797M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1798comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1799
1800**** Movement Commands
1801Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1802exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1803(c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1804
1805The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1806pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1807recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1808functions.
1809
1810**** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1811Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1812the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1813invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1814
1815*** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1816The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1817now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1818module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1819composition-close, and incomposition.
1820
1821*** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1822The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1823bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1824Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1825
1db7dd46
RS
1826*** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
1827controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
1828require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
1829c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
1830modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
1831Objective-C.
1832
1833The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
1834mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
b5a67081 1835
94b562dc
MS
1836*** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1837The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1838and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1839attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1840cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1841
1842((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1843
1844is now analysed as
1845
1846((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1847
1848In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1849symbol.
1850
1851This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1852and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1853the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1854with nil or an integer in the cdr.
b5a67081
MS
1855
1856*** API changes for derived modes.
1857There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1858derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1859incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1860care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1861Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1862
1863**** New language variable system.
1864See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1865
1866**** New initialization functions.
1867The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1868give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1869c-init-language-vars.
1870
1871*** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1872The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1873several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1874now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1875
1876This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1877although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1878gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1879where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1880it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1881
1882**** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1883This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1884its substatement. E.g:
1885
1886 if (x)
1887 x_is_true:
1888 do_stuff();
1889
1890*** Better handling of multiline macros.
1891
1892**** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1893The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1894syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1895variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1896cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1897inside #define's.
1898
1899**** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1900Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1901of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1902is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1903removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1904much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1905empty lines within the macro better.
1906
1907**** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1908This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1909c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1910
1911**** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1912c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1913variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1914backslashes can be moved.
1915
1916**** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1917This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1918affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1919inserted in auto-newline mode.
1920
1921**** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1922Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1923inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1924line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1925indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1926backslash) in the macro.
1927
1928*** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1929The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1930the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1931on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1932and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1933(something which was hardcoded earlier).
1934
1935*** New function c-context-open-line.
1936It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1937
1938*** New lineup functions
1939
1940**** c-lineup-string-cont
1941This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1942continues. E.g:
1943
1944result = prefix + "A message "
1945 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1946
1947**** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1948Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1949
1950**** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1951Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1952the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1953
1954**** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1955Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1956Ryde.
1957
1958**** c-lineup-argcont
1959Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1960Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1961
1962*** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1963CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1964of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1965places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1966improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1967moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1968
1969The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1970opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1971only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1972file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1973context.
1974
1975*** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1976Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1977"invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1978happen when macros are involved.
1979
1980*** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1981It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1982whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1983point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1984Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1985line is left untouched.
1986
1987*** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1988The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1989syntactic indentation.
1990
406f228c
PJ
1991** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1992--no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1993
1c6576ab 1994+++
7ea42709
RS
1995** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1996C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1997
1c6576ab 1998+++
3a426197 1999** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1c6576ab
RS
2000with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
2001whose names begin with space are omitted.
c30567b7 2002
2b6bb1f2 2003+++
3a426197
RS
2004** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
2005filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
2006fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
8e8223e2 2007
1c6576ab 2008+++
1d57ac82 2009** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
d1b2b8cc
RS
2010When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
2011starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1d57ac82 2012
2b6bb1f2 2013+++
2881ae98
SM
2014** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2015The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
54c0e682 2016When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
79014980 2017i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2881ae98 2018By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
54c0e682 2019from the file name or buffer contents.
79014980 2020
2b6bb1f2 2021+++
9252f7bc 2022** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
cb8d4d07 2023
2a1e884e 2024---
1c6576ab 2025** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
30de4b24 2026
1c6576ab
RS
2027---
2028** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
30de4b24 2029
2d588beb 2030+++
1c6576ab 2031** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2d588beb
GM
2032Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2033Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
a68c5400 2034
1c6576ab
RS
2035---
2036** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
0d9e03be 2037`f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
e47b1d49 2038
2c375837
GM
2039** F90 mode now has support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
2040It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2041majority.
2042
f607ff4b
GM
2043---
2044** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2045the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2046
1c6576ab
RS
2047---
2048** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2629d743
TTN
2049to support use of font-lock.
2050
1c6576ab 2051+++
026f408d
SM
2052** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
2053understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
2054`same-window'.
2055
1c6576ab 2056+++
6c0b2643
GM
2057** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
2058`${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
2059include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
2060
30743573 2061+++
58a11372
EZ
2062** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
2063If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
2064slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
2065completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
2066which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
2067candidate is a directory.
2068
1c6576ab 2069+++
af7272b1
RS
2070** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
2071to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1c6576ab
RS
2072it remains unchanged.
2073
6a4940b2
MY
2074** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
2075
2076Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
2077have in common and where they begin to differ.
2078
2079The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
2080`completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
2081same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
2082`completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
2083`completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
2084`completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
2085parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
2086parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
8bdbf30d 2087
2a1e884e 2088+++
6c0b2643
GM
2089** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
2090When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
2091displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
2092
2a1e884e 2093---
6c0b2643
GM
2094** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2095
2a1e884e 2096---
d3d268d5
JR
2097** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2098This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2099the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2100
2a1e884e 2101---
f58b2333
JR
2102** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2103See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2104
2a1e884e 2105---
3b7db268
JR
2106** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2107PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2108depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2109to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2110http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2111zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
9fc2be4c 2112against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
a3dde781 2113
f85bf1bf
JR
2114---
2115** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2116WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
6c098dbe 2117as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
f85bf1bf
JR
2118Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2119sound support for those formats.
2120
6c098dbe
JR
2121---
2122** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2123The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2124
1c6576ab 2125---
01a7f683
JR
2126** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2127The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2128whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2129pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2130
d18c4f98
JR
2131---
2132** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
d1b2b8cc
RS
2133The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2134the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2135colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2136default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2137some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2138`list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2139you wish to use them in other faces.
d18c4f98 2140
2b6bb1f2 2141+++
98659da6
KG
2142** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2143The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2144and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2145use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2146Meta and Alt:
2147 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2148 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
7aa518f3 2149
1ce8d8b1 2150+++
7aa518f3
AS
2151** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2152
2153In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2154enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2155to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2156
2157 P: annotates the previous revision
2158 N: annotates the next revision
2159 J: annotates the revision at line
2160 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2161 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2162 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2163 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
d82baff9
KS
2164
2165+++
2166** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2167between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2168in the repository.
2169
5dc0a68b
JL
2170+++
2171** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2172anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2173"checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2174-rBASE -rHEAD.
2175
f3e4c362
TTN
2176** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2177used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2178handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2179temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2180
a28e0218
KH
2181** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
2182coding system.
2183
46937ad8 2184\f
4581649e 2185* New modes and packages in Emacs 21.4
8f8da2d0 2186
c7eb99ce
DP
2187** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2188varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2189var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2190section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2191.config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2192recognized.
2193
3d3b45dc
SJ
2194** The new package password.el provide a password cache and expiring mechanism.
2195
a3ba1a6a
SJ
2196** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2197The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2198to increment the SOA serial.
2199
3fc3e0a6
JL
2200** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2201source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2202
a422e170
DP
2203** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2204of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2205well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2206
723addae 2207** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
033ad8c6
SM
2208buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2209
723addae
EZ
2210** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2211and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2212
1e88a355
SM
2213** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2214
f8f853de
SM
2215** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2216
5df034de
LK
2217+++
2218** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2219shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2220
a95cefd7 2221** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
556621f6 2222
8f8da2d0 2223---
cd3782b4
KS
2224** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2225
2226The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2227package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2228to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2229a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
ffe5000a 2230
2b6bb1f2 2231---
cd3782b4
KS
2232** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2233
2234The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2461722b
KS
2235cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2236With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2237keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2238region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2239cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2240
2241In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2242rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2243using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2244or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2245
2246Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2247fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2248downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2249rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2250as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2251M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2252rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2253
2254Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2255prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2256C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2257
2258The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2259register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2260
2261Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2262When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2263automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2264commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2265
2266The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2267kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2268want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2269`cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2270
cd3782b4
KS
2271Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2272versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2273must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2274loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2275
4e5cdb4f 2276** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
7920598e
KS
2277the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2278keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2279+, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2280package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2281
2282By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2283`keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2284using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2285the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2286possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2287the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2288
2289The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2290`Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2291`Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2292decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2293`Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2294for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2295where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
63e489f5
KS
2296`Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2297are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2298or local keymaps.
2461722b 2299
d82baff9 2300+++
4e5cdb4f 2301** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
ffe5000a
KS
2302emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2303
e1fa392b
KS
2304Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2305F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2306the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
ffe5000a
KS
2307which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2308
cc801373
KS
2309There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2310defined macros.
2311
2312The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2313defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2314C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2315manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2316C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2317for more commands.
2318
2c37653c 2319The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
cc801373 2320the keyboard macro ring.
ffe5000a 2321
f1f83e21
KS
2322The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2323before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
e1fa392b
KS
2324
2325In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2326be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2327this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2328kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2329
f1f83e21 2330Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
d1b2b8cc 2331C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
f1f83e21
KS
2332at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2333
675d000f
RS
2334---
2335** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2336to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2337bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2338C-c C-i b, and so on.
2339
cd3782b4
KS
2340** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2341
2342If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2343the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2344with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2345ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2346printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2347`ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2348
66f520db 2349+++
4e5cdb4f 2350** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
66f520db
EZ
2351
2352Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2353Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
52901be1
EZ
2354type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2355available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
66f520db 2356
10088409 2357+++
4e5cdb4f 2358** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
c3d82b69
KG
2359
2360This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2361files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2362Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2363for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2364the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2365`inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2366connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2367(which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2368`rsync' to do the copying).
2369
2370Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2371`su' and `sudo'.
2372
2a1e884e 2373---
4e5cdb4f 2374** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
49a42d13
MB
2375filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2376that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2377emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2378invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2379be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
4e3dd7cf 2380
2b6bb1f2 2381---
4e5cdb4f 2382** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
3c0fd84c
GM
2383"active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2384change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2385settings.
2386
2b6bb1f2 2387---
4e5cdb4f 2388** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
a95cefd7 2389move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
8a1f8073
SM
2390It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2391of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2392
2a1e884e 2393There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
adb6f9dc 2394
2a1e884e 2395---
4e5cdb4f 2396** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
81f755ae
CW
2397customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2398
4e5cdb4f 2399** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
813f3d41
RS
2400`text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2401these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2402table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2403can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2404as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2405
9cc1eb89 2406+++
4e5cdb4f
KS
2407** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2408spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2409letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2410viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2411
2a1e884e
RS
2412---
2413** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
4e3dd7cf
MB
2414Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2415to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2416mode-lines in inverse-video.
2417
9252f7bc 2418---
eb6055fa 2419** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
a8adf791 2420
500ae430
DL
2421** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2422timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2423
bcdf2143 2424** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
46937ad8
DL
2425
2426** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2427configuration files.
6c0b2643 2428\f
d278091b 2429* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
851e5562 2430
4ae98fc5
RS
2431+++
2432** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
2433save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
2434(if it's modified).
2435
56011a8c
RS
2436+++
2437** The function symbol-file tells you which file defined
2438a certain function or variable.
2439
c44edf72
KS
2440** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
2441clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
2442function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
2443
414ac1a3 2444+++
1113094c 2445** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
d9c1ce9d
RS
2446arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
2447quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
2448finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
2449
414ac1a3
RS
2450+++
2451** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
2452precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
2453will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
2454`magic-mode-alist'.
2455
2456+++
2457** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
2458the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
2459back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
2460
2461+++
2462** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
2463`progress-reporter-force-update' and `progress-reporter-done' provide
fda2922a
RS
2464a simple and efficient way for a command to present progress messages
2465for the user.
414ac1a3 2466
593b3517
RS
2467---
2468** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
2469proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
2470"files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
2471several versions ago.
2472
9d00469f
RS
2473+++
2474** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2475saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2476
dedbac89
RS
2477+++
2478** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2479for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2480regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2481expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2482
2483Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2484replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2485
ee31cd78
RS
2486---
2487** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2488If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2489
2490---
2491** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
2492NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
2493
ae8bbb42 2494+++
18819b0f
RS
2495** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
2496of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
2497of text properties as well as the character code.
18819b0f 2498
66fcf39c
EZ
2499+++
2500** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
2501run time used by Emacs since start-up.
2502
2d1ef312
RS
2503+++
2504** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
6dd06769
LT
2505have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
2506calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
2507only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
2508command.
2509
2510+++
2511** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
2512`assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
2513been declared obsolete.
2d1ef312 2514
c8636435
KS
2515+++
2516** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2517the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2518previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2519
d0ee2ed3
KH
2520** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2521argument.
2522
143e9e6a 2523+++
7320911b 2524** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
6622d928 2525`after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
7320911b 2526
a020987f
LT
2527+++
2528** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2529`buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2530
c90e7e43
LT
2531+++
2532** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
8392e138 2533been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
c90e7e43
LT
2534`disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2535
0f7a93c1
KS
2536** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2537width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2538the usable window height and width is used.
2539
cbbfedb2
LT
2540+++
2541** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2542a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2543
2544** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
02c04e6f
RS
2545enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2546During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2547is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2548it changes to nil.
376de739 2549
092de21d
RS
2550+++
2551** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2552
2553You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2554same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2555example,
2556
2557(kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2558
0b0dea7b 2559** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2e2d7ee6
KS
2560delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2561deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2562sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2563changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2564
08fd1251
RS
2565** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2566undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2567it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2568
092de21d 2569---
d6696bb6
KH
2570** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2571current input method to input a character.
2572
092de21d
RS
2573+++
2574** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
b144fc11
RS
2575click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2576position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
09fe18d3 2577
5b3dedcc
RS
2578** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2579character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2580and ranges.
2581
b144fc11
RS
2582** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2583and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2584arg is non-nil.
09fe18d3 2585
98a51048
JPW
2586** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2587
08818866
EZ
2588+++
2589** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2590modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2591operation.
2592
ed2846bd 2593+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2594** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2595supported on text terminals.
2596
ed2846bd 2597+++
09fe18d3
KS
2598** Support for displaying image slices
2599
2600*** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2601an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2602
2603*** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2604specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2605
2606*** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2607specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2608
ed2846bd 2609+++
06859ebd 2610** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
e5847e56 2611
26fb226b
KS
2612A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2613properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
e5847e56 2614
06859ebd
KS
2615If the line-height property value is 0, the newline does not
2616contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
6ab66799
KS
2617newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2618newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2619slices without adding blank areas between the images.
e5847e56 2620
06859ebd
KS
2621If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2622specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2623height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
e5847e56 2624
06859ebd 2625If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
e71caa4e
KS
2626is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2627given value.
06859ebd 2628
e71caa4e
KS
2629If the line-height property value is a cons (RATIO . FACE), the
2630minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2631RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
06859ebd 2632
e71caa4e
KS
2633If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2634is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2635overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2636the line-spacing variable.
06859ebd 2637
e71caa4e
KS
2638If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2639is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2640
6ab66799
KS
2641If the line-spacing value is a cons (total . SPACING) where SPACING is
2642any of the forms described above, the value of SPACING is used as the
2643total height of the line, i.e. a varying number of pixels are inserted
2644after each line to make each line exactly that many pixels high.
2645
e71caa4e
KS
2646** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
2647which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
09fe18d3 2648
ed2846bd 2649+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2650** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2651
2652The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2653PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
e4aaf69c 2654specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
c1cbc25a
KS
2655
2656The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2657which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2658are supported:
2659
2660EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2661NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2662UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2663ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2664 | scroll-bar | text
2665POS ::= left | center | right
2666FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2667OP ::= + | -
2668
2669The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2670frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2671pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2672is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2673pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2674`height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2675font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2676the image.
2677
2678The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2679`scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
e4aaf69c 2680corresponding area of the window.
c1cbc25a
KS
2681
2682The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2683to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2684of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2685can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2686relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2687a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2688these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2689the width of the area.
2690
2691For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2692 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2693
2694If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2695to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2696header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2697
2698The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2699the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2700width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2701height) of the specified image.
2702
2703The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2704The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2705
ed2846bd 2706+++
4e14f66c
KS
2707** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
2708text property string that may be present at the current window
2709position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
2710strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
2711
982c8d45
SM
2712** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2713around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2714and post-command-hooks.
2715
d9c1ce9d
RS
2716** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
2717`default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
2718defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
2719by them).
d3a403e5 2720
11a365f9
EZ
2721+++
2722** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2723to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2724foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2725a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2726preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2727use of the capabilities of the display.
b19ac475 2728
ed2846bd
KS
2729+++
2730** Customizable fringe bitmaps
2731
f2a54fbc
KS
2732*** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
2733fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
b2b681f1 2734
f2a54fbc
KS
2735To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
2736identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
b2b681f1 2737
ed2846bd 2738*** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
b2b681f1
KS
2739previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2740
ed2846bd 2741*** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
b2b681f1
KS
2742specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2743this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2744the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2745
ed2846bd 2746*** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
b2b681f1
KS
2747that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2748bitmap of the display line.
2749
2750Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
f2a54fbc 2751symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
b2b681f1
KS
2752`define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2753for displaying the bitmap.
2754
35ab4857
KS
2755*** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
2756bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
b2b681f1 2757
851e5562
KS
2758** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2759variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2760varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2761the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2762
2763Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2764and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2765string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2766systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2767If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
2768'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
2769
4372d886
KS
2770+++
2771** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2772line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2773number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2774
9f4b6e73 2775+++
e91408d7
KH
2776** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2777variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
ac459e8a 2778that end a sentence without following spaces.
e91408d7 2779
9f4b6e73 2780+++
8bc51bd1
JL
2781** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
2782the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
2783then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2784`sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2785`sentence-end-without-space'.
2786
b19ac475
JY
2787+++
2788** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
2789`format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
2790implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
830047fd 2791
0610f22f
MB
2792** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2793It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2794One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2795if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2796
9adcb5f2 2797+++
d0cd7210
LT
2798** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
2799from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
43e48bda 2800the first one is kept.
d0cd7210 2801
3e7274ae
LT
2802+++
2803** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
2804documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
2805
652dd271
SJ
2806** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2807before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2808tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2809sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2810
e2b9b51f 2811+++
53092de4
EZ
2812** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
2813`yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
2814string. The old behavior is available if you call
2815`insert-for-yank-1' instead.
2816
d18473b9
LT
2817** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
2818arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
2819return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
2820whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
2821it was found as a text property or not found at all.
2822
ed2846bd
KS
2823+++ (lispref)
2824??? (man)
69348b2a
KS
2825** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
2826line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
2827controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
2828is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
2829(or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
2830
ed2846bd 2831+++
69348b2a
KS
2832** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
2833:pointer image property.
2834
ed2846bd 2835+++
69348b2a
KS
2836** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
2837controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
2838
ed2846bd 2839+++
69348b2a
KS
2840** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
2841
2842An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
2843An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
2844A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
2845pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
2846A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
2847and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
2848A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
2849vector describes one corner in the polygon.
2850
2851When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
2852PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
2853property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
2854a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
2855it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
2856for possible pointer shapes.
2857
2858When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
2859an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
2860mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
2861
5f6eef94
KS
2862** Mouse event enhancements:
2863
2864*** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
2865events, rather than a text area click event.
2866
05faee07
KS
2867*** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
2868sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
2869corresponding text row.
2870
2871*** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
2872
5f6eef94
KS
2873+++
2874*** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
2875
2876+++
2877*** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
2878
5f6eef94 2879+++
3999c705 2880*** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
5f6eef94
KS
2881text area).
2882
2883+++
2884*** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
2885
2886+++
2887*** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
2888
d46aeafc
KS
2889+++
2890*** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
2891
2892+++
2893*** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
d18473b9 2894the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
d46aeafc 2895
05faee07
KS
2896+++
2897*** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
2898(image or character) clicked on.
2899
2900+++
2901*** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
2902'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
2903click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
2904of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
d46aeafc 2905
5f6eef94
KS
2906** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
2907one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
2908contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
2909changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
2910forcing an explicit window update.
2911
2912** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
2913debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
2914
76bf15e9
LT
2915+++
2916** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
2917the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
2918SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
2919nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
2920empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
2921
06a49fc1
LT
2922+++
2923** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
2924
c6177909
LT
2925+++
2926** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
2927new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
2928beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
2929documented.
2930
01b70437
DL
2931** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
2932locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
2933the language.
2934
d18473b9 2935---
4a29bad2
DL
2936** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
2937the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
2938parts, e.g. utf-16.
2939
f6537e03 2940+++
0e7d7aae
RS
2941** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2942and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2943
f6537e03
RS
2944+++
2945** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2946to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2947a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2948
2949Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2950does that, this value may not be accurate.
2951
51a8b435 2952+++
c6de56a0
RS
2953** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2954actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2955divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2956the mode line.
2957
51a8b435 2958+++
c6de56a0
RS
2959** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2960return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2961
51a8b435 2962+++
bf078377
SM
2963** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2964
51a8b435
RS
2965+++
2966** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2967`switch-to-buffer'.
9c0fb8b9 2968
51a8b435
RS
2969+++
2970** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2971selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2972
2973+++
2974** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2975text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2976works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
9c0fb8b9 2977
51a8b435 2978+++
c64a682c
SM
2979** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2980in the keymap.
2981
51a8b435 2982---
c64a682c
SM
2983** VC changes for backends:
2984*** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2985*** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2986parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2987Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2988uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2989
51a8b435 2990+++
c6de56a0
RS
2991** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2992as a dynamic completion table.
2993
2994 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2995
2996FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2997and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2998completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2999can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3000minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3001entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
3002
51a8b435 3003+++
c6de56a0
RS
3004** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
3005as a lazy completion table.
3006
3007 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3008
3009If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3010as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3011ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3012completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3013from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3014`lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3015
51a8b435 3016+++
5ceea398
RS
3017** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
3018
e50886d3
RS
3019+++
3020** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5ceea398
RS
3021for all (existing and future) frames.
3022
51a8b435 3023+++
5ceea398 3024** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
052797a7 3025
51a8b435 3026+++
052797a7
SM
3027** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
3028
51a8b435 3029+++
052797a7
SM
3030** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
3031
e50886d3 3032+++
211a9f6b
KH
3033** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
3034(or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
87a4ed45 3035'((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
211a9f6b
KH
3036point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
3037SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
3038
e50886d3 3039+++
eb67c5d6
RS
3040** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3041numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3042By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3043as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3044
e50886d3 3045+++
5d0ab731 3046** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
b0ada147
RS
3047specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3048many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3049`file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3050
e50886d3 3051---
32d0a9dc
KH
3052** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
3053the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
3054
e50886d3 3055+++
63a08a73 3056** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
b23375aa
KS
3057unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3058in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3059In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3060
e50886d3 3061+++
ce4254bd
KH
3062** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
3063of a string given to a process's filter.
3064
e50886d3 3065+++
ce4254bd
KH
3066** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
3067a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
3068
e50886d3 3069+++
ce4254bd
KH
3070** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
3071the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
3072value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3073created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3074
e50886d3 3075+++
ce4254bd
KH
3076** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
3077buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3078to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3079Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3080which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
3081
e50886d3 3082+++
b08d5f59
KH
3083** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3084multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3085
e50886d3 3086+++
6eed9bed
DL
3087** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3088on garbage collection.
3089
e50886d3 3090+++
b08d5f59
KH
3091** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
3092it is read from a file without decoding.
b6c2aa59 3093
e50886d3
RS
3094+++
3095** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
175573ac 3096
e50886d3 3097+++
2155ecf3
RS
3098** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3099of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3100by calling `select-window'.
3101
e50886d3 3102---
2155ecf3
RS
3103** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
3104if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
3105into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
3106need to have a name.
3107
f08830d2
DL
3108** Byte compiler changes:
3109
e50886d3 3110---
f08830d2
DL
3111*** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
3112helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
3113Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
3114efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
3115generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
3116you anything.
3117
e50886d3 3118+++
f08830d2
DL
3119*** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
3120simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
3121useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
3122Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
3123forms:
3124
3125 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
3126 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
3127
3128In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
3129won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
3130second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
3131unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
3132macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
3133`unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
c60ee5e7 3134
e50886d3
RS
3135+++
3136*** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
3137inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
3138
3139+++
3140** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3141is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3142be inserted is translated through it.
a4ac5b17 3143
9252f7bc
RS
3144+++
3145** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
a4ac5b17 3146which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
9252f7bc
RS
3147current file redefined it).
3148
56011a8c
RS
3149+++
3150** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
3151defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
3152
e50886d3 3153+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3154** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
3155whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
3156instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
3157testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
3158show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
3159a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
3160
3161*** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
3162a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
3163splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
3164such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
3165to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
3166
3167*** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
9f8a930d
JY
3168out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
3169It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
3170suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
3171during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
3172returns differing values.
d2d70cb6 3173
9cc1eb89 3174+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3175** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
3176do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
3177unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
3178
e50886d3
RS
3179+++
3180** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3181that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3182numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3183when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3184
3185When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3186also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3116d142 3187
e50886d3 3188+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3189** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3190the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3191
e50886d3 3192+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3193** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3194is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3195
21beb82f 3196+++
add89676
RS
3197** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
3198It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
21beb82f 3199can start with this line:
add89676
RS
3200
3201 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
3202
3bd7a6ed
TTN
3203** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
3204Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
3205appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
3206
3207 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
3208
3209Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
3210in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
3211
e50886d3 3212+++
02ce3e80
SM
3213** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3214its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3215
e50886d3 3216---
fc2938d1
DL
3217** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
3218hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3219
e50886d3 3220+++
3bcd2096
JPW
3221** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3222argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3223the current buffer.
79fab26b 3224
c5e0561f 3225+++
56592beb
RS
3226** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3227and `display-warning'.
3228
e50886d3 3229+++
a7bd9dc7
SM
3230** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3231of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3232and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3233exported to Lisp.
3234
e50886d3 3235---
1c6576ab
RS
3236** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3237much pure storage it will approximately need.
3238
e50886d3 3239+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3240** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3241to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3242for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3243file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3244
e50886d3 3245---
cc305a60
RS
3246** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3247of one coding system from another coding system.
3248
661e85c1 3249+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3250** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3251are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3252specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3253such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3254needed.
3255
c5e0561f 3256---
2b6bb1f2
RS
3257** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3258that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3259appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3260is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3261ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3262with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3263
3264If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3265confirmation as before.
3266
c5e0561f 3267+++
6f8968c8 3268** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2b6bb1f2 3269
6f8968c8
KS
3270The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3271can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3272frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3273Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2b6bb1f2 3274
6f8968c8
KS
3275The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3276specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3277integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3278between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3279specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3280only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2b6bb1f2
RS
3281
3282Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3283width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3284of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3285fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3286
c5e0561f 3287+++
6f8968c8
KS
3288** Per-window fringes settings
3289
3290Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3291settings.
3292
3293To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3294variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3295`set-window-fringes'.
3296
3297To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3298are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3299or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3300`fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3301
3302The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3303settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3304`fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3305displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3306an update of the display margins.
3307
f6537e03 3308+++
6f8968c8
KS
3309** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3310
3311Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3312controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3313
3314To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3315variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3316`set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3317used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3318`scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3319the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3320of the display margins.
3321
c5e0561f 3322+++
6f8968c8
KS
3323** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3324KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3325and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3326
f2aa473a 3327+++
2d586478 3328** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
2881ae98
SM
3329find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3330find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3331write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
2d586478
SM
3332write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
3333x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
3334x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
2881ae98
SM
3335Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3336
c5e0561f 3337+++
c60ee5e7 3338** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
7757cdaf
JPW
3339It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3340name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3341
c5e0561f 3342+++
02f20f98
KS
3343** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3344specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3345new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3346while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3347variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3348
c5e0561f 3349---
02f20f98
KS
3350** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3351to override the internal read-file-name function.
3352
94966e2b
JPW
3353
3354** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3355whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3356`read-file-name' function.
3357
c5e0561f 3358+++
21b6d966
KS
3359** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3360`read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3361will only show directories.
3362
c5e0561f 3363+++
af7272b1
RS
3364** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3365non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3366its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
261b01c6 3367The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
af7272b1 3368
c5e0561f 3369---
af7272b1
RS
3370** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3371now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3372(require 'cl) when loaded.
3373
c5e0561f 3374+++
ee9e0c25
GM
3375** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3376indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3377syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3378
3379 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3380
3381DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3382declaration specifiers supported are:
3383
3384(indent INDENT)
3385 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3386
3387(edebug DEBUG)
3388 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3389 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3390
0e7d7aae 3391+++
93607efd
KS
3392** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3393
3394This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
dfd67a62 3395to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
93607efd
KS
3396binding and lookup functionality.
3397
3398When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3399remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3400original command.
3401
3402Example:
3403Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3404my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3405bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3406kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3407kill-word.
3408
3409Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3410command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3411my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3412map using define-key:
3413
a8959ac2
KS
3414 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3415 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
93607efd
KS
3416
3417Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3418the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3419
3420Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3421example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3422then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3423
3424The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3425
a8959ac2
KS
3426- Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3427 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3428 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3429 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
93607efd 3430
a84db054
KS
3431- The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3432 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
93607efd
KS
3433
3434- key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
a8959ac2 3435 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
93607efd
KS
3436
3437- where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3438 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3439 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3440 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3441 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3442 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3443
3444- The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3445 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3446 command was not remapped.
3447
0e7d7aae 3448+++
3f21fb3a
KS
3449** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3450
3451Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3452keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3453alist to this list.
3454
f6537e03 3455+++
108eaabb
RS
3456** Atomic change groups.
3457
3458To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3459they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3460around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3461
3462 (atomic-change-group
3463 (insert foo)
3464 (delete-region x y))
3465
3466If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3467`atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3468were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3469on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3470
3471If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3472lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3473
3474To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3475Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3476This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3477the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3478
3479Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3480group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3481do this.
3482
3483After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3484either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3485`accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3486call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3487
3488You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3489finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3490`unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3491(This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3492`activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3493group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3494twice.
3495
3496To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3497for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3498returned values, like this:
3499
3500 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3501 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3502
3503You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3504to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3505`accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3506
3507Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3508would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3509will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3510change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3511finished.
3512
f17c0a19
CW
3513+++
3514** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3515
3516This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3517properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3518although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3519to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3520
0e7d7aae 3521+++
f17c0a19
CW
3522** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3523
3524This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3525M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3526property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3527new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3528
0e7d7aae 3529+++
d9f7eb77
RS
3530** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3531
3532The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3533as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3534a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3535
0e7d7aae 3536+++
18232c16 3537** New function insert-for-yank.
d278091b 3538
18232c16
KS
3539This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3540properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3541inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3542character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3543a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3544
0e7d7aae 3545+++
18232c16
KS
3546** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3547
3548This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3549text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
d278091b 3550
0e7d7aae 3551+++
d278091b
KS
3552** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3553
18232c16
KS
3554This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3555text properties from the inserted substring.
3556
0e7d7aae 3557+++
18232c16
KS
3558** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3559previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3560
0e7d7aae 3561The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
18232c16 3562elements with the following format:
a6098104 3563 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
18232c16
KS
3564
3565The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3566the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3567element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3568the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3569
3570 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3571to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3572 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3573passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3574`yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3575rectangle.
3576 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3577yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3578responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3579if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3580 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3581by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
c60ee5e7 3582called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
18232c16 3583FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
18232c16 3584
0e7d7aae
RS
3585*** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3586optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3587the killed text.
18232c16
KS
3588
3589*** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3590`yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3591yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3592insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3593element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3594
f6537e03 3595+++
11ef2a3b
MB
3596** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3597whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3598
3599A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3600specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3601defined with defface.
3602
7e07a66d
MB
3603** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3604given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3605it did only a very cursory check).
3606
f6537e03 3607+++
3d619ea1
MB
3608** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3609accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3610inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3611
f6537e03 3612+++
3d619ea1
MB
3613** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3614help with handling relative face attributes.
3615
a0a23346
MB
3616** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3617If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3618faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3619of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3620:inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3621properties.
3622
f6537e03 3623+++
15aeeda5
KS
3624** Enhancements to process support
3625
3626*** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3627only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3628
3629*** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3630functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3631supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3632
3633*** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3634name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3635
e519464c 3636*** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
c60ee5e7 3637maintain process state and other per-process related information.
e519464c
KS
3638
3639The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3640and modify elements on this property list.
3641
3642The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3643used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3644
101c421e
KS
3645*** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3646`just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3647is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3648integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3649recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3650speech synthesis.
3651
31e0fbdd
KS
3652*** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3653
3654On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3655output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3656very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
3657by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3658non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3659from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3660emacs tries to read it.
3661
f6537e03 3662+++
fd13a3cc 3663** Enhanced networking support.
1e892206 3664
fd13a3cc
KS
3665*** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3666opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3667create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
1e892206 3668
fd13a3cc 3669- A server is started using :server t arg.
60a501d7 3670- Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
fd13a3cc
KS
3671- A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3672- Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3673- Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
e519464c
KS
3674- The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3675 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3676 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
1e892206 3677
60a501d7
KS
3678To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3679 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3680
fd13a3cc
KS
3681*** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3682
3683*** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3684
3685This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
8e9e520b
KS
3686without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3687filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3688connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3689matching "open" or "failed".
fd13a3cc
KS
3690
3691*** New function open-network-stream-server.
8e9e520b
KS
3692
3693This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3694When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3695is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3696is called for the new process.
fd13a3cc
KS
3697
3698*** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3699
3700These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3701and set the current address of the remote partner.
fd13a3cc 3702
4e5cdb4f 3703*** New function format-network-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3704
3705This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3706to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3707number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3708printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3709string for other formatting options.
4e5cdb4f 3710
fd13a3cc
KS
3711*** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3712for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3713of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3714
3715Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3716remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3717element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3718the fifth is the port number.
3719
3720*** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3721`stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3722connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3723no input is received in the stopped state.
3724
205f1dde
KS
3725*** New function network-interface-list.
3726
3727This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3728current network addresses.
3729
0c4da023 3730*** New function network-interface-info.
205f1dde
KS
3731
3732This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3733status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3734
f6537e03 3735+++
6ba3d6bc
CW
3736** New function copy-tree.
3737
f6537e03 3738+++
9ade4a7d
RS
3739** New function substring-no-properties.
3740
f6537e03 3741+++
3bdb7f80
KS
3742** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3743
f6537e03 3744+++
4e3dd7cf
MB
3745** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3746
213856ba
KG
3747** New function `process-file'.
3748
3749This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
3750handler is chosen based on default-directory.
3751
f6537e03 3752---
f6078b98
RS
3753** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3754are now always lower case. If you specify the
3755menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3756as the "key" bound by that key binding.
3757
3758This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
3759the bindings that were made with easymenu.
3760
0e7d7aae 3761+++
f6078b98
RS
3762** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
3763argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
3764for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
3765and does not return t for keyboard macros.
3766
f6537e03 3767---
2a1e884e
RS
3768** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
3769buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
3770
3771It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
3772and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
3773buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
3774commands.
3775
3776This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
3777sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
3778SQL buffer.
3779
3780(add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
3781 (function (lambda ()
3782 (master-mode t)
3783 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3784(add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
3785 (function (lambda ()
3786 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3787
f6537e03 3788+++
596d02bc
RS
3789** File local variables.
3790
3791A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3792properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3793
d33c4505
RS
3794+++
3795** New function window-body-height.
3796
3797This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3798or the header line.
3799
0e7d7aae 3800+++
21b6d966
KS
3801** New function format-mode-line.
3802
3803This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
f4d7915c 3804specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
21b6d966 3805
9f89426b
KS
3806+++
3807** New function safe-plist-get.
3808
3809This function is like plist-get, but never signals an error for
3810a malformed property list.
3811
0e7d7aae 3812+++
9356fe5a
RS
3813** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3814
3815These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
3816compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3817
0e7d7aae 3818+++
4f4fada2
RS
3819** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
3820
9252f7bc 3821The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4f4fada2
RS
3822recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
3823Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
3824you specify the map to use as an argument.
3825
c4f59bcf
EZ
3826+++
3827** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3828
3829When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3830angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3831equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3832
75e20bec
RS
3833+++
3834** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3835
3836A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3837line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3838`header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3839cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3840variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3841
e0c124ce
EZ
3842+++
3843** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3844for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3845number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3846Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3847
bc3b02f9
LK
3848+++
3849** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
3850used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
3851
86b9b767
LK
3852+++
3853** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3854:propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3855`risky-local-variable' property is nil.
596d02bc 3856
5df034de
LK
3857+++
3858** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
3859to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
3860line.
3861
1c6576ab
RS
3862---
3863** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
3864cl-indent package. The new user options
3865`lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
3866`lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
3867indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
3868
3869---
3870** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
3871cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3872
1ae7cf5e 3873+++
aaddfb29
RS
3874** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
3875
3876Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
3877from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
3878buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
3879now:
3880
38811. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
3882
38832. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
3884the time it takes to convert the format.
3885
38863. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
3887wasteful.
3888
1ae7cf5e 3889+++
edde72f6
RS
3890** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3891over minor mode keymaps.
3892
1ae7cf5e 3893+++
0065bb74
RS
3894** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3895An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3896
1ae7cf5e 3897+++
5ceea398
RS
3898** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3899text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3900image or composition property.
3901
c64a682c
SM
3902This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3903This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3904unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3905(including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3906post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5d0ab731 3907
51a8b435 3908+++
bf36a6d3
MB
3909** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
3910argument, LIMIT.
4e02881b 3911
ef8aee62 3912+++
1b8c66fe
RS
3913** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3914non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3915it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3916Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3917flag.
3918
51a8b435 3919---
c95eaa61
PJ
3920** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3921
51a8b435 3922---
c95eaa61
PJ
3923** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
3924
51a8b435 3925---
111ed14e
SM
3926** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3927Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3928find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3929that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3930handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3931In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3932
51a8b435 3933---
cfaa4a1b 3934** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
59b59892
SM
3935Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3936bindings of the parent keymap.
cfaa4a1b 3937
51a8b435 3938---
f67cc62e
SM
3939** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3940If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3941(see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3942be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3943depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3944is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3945
3946 s{
3947 foo
3948 }{
3949 bar
3950 }e
3951
3952Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3953text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3954property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3955refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3956
51a8b435 3957---
6710ea06 3958** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
fbe51115 3959called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
6710ea06 3960
16927a56 3961** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
d18473b9 3962(the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
16927a56 3963
51a8b435 3964+++
16927a56
SM
3965** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
3966it receives a request from emacsclient.
3967
51a8b435 3968---
8727d588
RS
3969** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
3970Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
3971than 3 levels of nesting.
3972
51a8b435 3973---
1c1d3d69
RS
3974** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3975property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3976it in that buffer.
3977
51a8b435 3978---
ae4000f1 3979** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
1ff74324 3980properties from surrounding text.
1c1d3d69 3981
bcdf2143 3982+++
d1b2b8cc
RS
3983** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3984element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3985accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
bcdf2143 3986
51a8b435 3987+++
830047fd
RS
3988** New function `buffer-local-value'.
3989
830047fd
RS
3990This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
3991in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
3992buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
6c0b2643 3993
51a8b435 3994---
8e8223e2
SM
3995** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3996that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3997clone to the other.
3998
51a8b435 3999+++
8e8223e2
SM
4000** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4001*** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
d390f4aa 4002of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
8e8223e2
SM
4003other properties than `face'.
4004*** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
4005properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4006
51a8b435 4007---
0df7a0b6
EZ
4008** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4009or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
51a8b435
RS
4010`defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4011the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4012directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
0df7a0b6 4013
51a8b435 4014+++
8e8223e2
SM
4015** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4016are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
4017parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4018
51a8b435 4019+++
0ec6b206
SM
4020** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4021and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
4022
51a8b435 4023+++
7c3cb37d
RS
4024** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4025It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4026
a7bd9dc7 4027+++
8e8223e2
SM
4028** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4029to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
7bea57c9 4030and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
8e8223e2 4031
202082d3
EZ
4032+++
4033** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4034ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4035`.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4036
51a8b435 4037+++
63ca0a6e
GM
4038** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4039user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4040accepts a float as UID parameter.
4041
51a8b435 4042---
30de4b24
SM
4043** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4044
51a8b435 4045+++
30de4b24
SM
4046** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4047
51a8b435 4048+++
1c6576ab
RS
4049** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
4050character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
4051of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
4052the output of other GNU tools.
4053
51a8b435 4054+++
026f408d
SM
4055** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
4056
51a8b435 4057---
026f408d
SM
4058** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
4059
51a8b435 4060+++
026f408d
SM
4061** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4062searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
4063
51a8b435 4064+++
cb8d4d07 4065** Variable aliases have been implemented:
6c0b2643 4066
51a8b435 4067*** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
6c0b2643 4068
3fdb4c50
JB
4069This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
4070symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
4071returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
4072changes the value of BASE-VAR.
6c0b2643 4073
32ebbc3a
JB
4074DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
4075the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
4076
51a8b435 4077*** indirect-variable VARIABLE
6c0b2643
GM
4078
4079This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
4080of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
4081defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
4082
4083It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
4084variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
4085
51a8b435 4086+++
6c0b2643
GM
4087** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
4088collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4089
51a8b435 4090+++
ace64e0a
GM
4091** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
4092the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
4093
51a8b435 4094+++
123ac55e 4095** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
51a8b435 4096hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
123ac55e 4097
51a8b435 4098---
0b559506
JR
4099** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4100The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4101formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4102
51a8b435
RS
4103** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
4104display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
6b3daede
GM
4105using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4106
c94472fc
JD
4107** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4108running under X.
4109
f24485f1 4110** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
e71caa4e 4111all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
f24485f1 4112
30de4b24
SM
4113** New packages:
4114
71c88486
NR
4115*** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
4116GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
4117there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
4118state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
f2afecda
NR
4119that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
4120Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
71c88486
NR
4121
4122Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
4123
30de4b24
SM
4124*** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4125current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4126
ffe5000a
KS
4127*** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4128binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4129data structures.
4130
e95768c5 4131*** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
c494f663
CW
4132This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4133
4e3dd7cf
MB
4134*** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4135in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4136implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4137require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4138as help and apropos buffers.
4139
6c0b2643 4140\f
71c88486
NR
4141* Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4142
4143** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4144been added.
4145
4146\f
4147* Changes in Emacs 21.3
4148
4149** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4150with Custom.
4151
4152** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
2d2ff530 4153as mule-utf-8.
71c88486
NR
4154
4155** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4156in UTF-8 locales).
4157
4158** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4159different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4160Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4161and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4162between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4163(e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4164`unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4165`unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4166it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4167By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4168
4169** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4170`selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4171
4172If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4173compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4174compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4175text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
4176contrary to the compound text specification.
4177
4178\f
4179* Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4180
4181** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4182
4183** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4184
4185\f
4186* Changes in Emacs 21.2
4187
4188** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4189
4190X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4191compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4192list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4193selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4194compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4195
4196** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4197were changed.
4198
4199** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4200now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4201
4202** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4203initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4204instead of using default-major-mode.
4205
4206** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4207like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4208as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4209(the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4210visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4211is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4212to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4213
4214This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4215NEWS.
4216
4217\f
4218* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4219
4220** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4221have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4222and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4223
4224** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4225be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4226
4227\f
251584f3
DL
4228* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4229
889be0a1
DL
4230See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4231fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4232charsets in this release.
4233
f4988be7
GM
4234** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4235
424d8b44
DL
4236** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4237
1fa28578 4238** There are new configure options associated with the support for
163ea954
RS
4239images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4240to list them.
6344985d 4241
5ed8d5af 4242** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
60dd7e0e 4243support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
8628686a
DL
4244maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4245build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4246necessary changes to unexec.
f4988be7 4247
efeb796b
EZ
4248** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4249Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4250
4251** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4252Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4253
4254** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4255the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
d9c9b920 4256
e90813b8 4257** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
a7c13351 4258all of the new display features described below. The port currently
d69aa2e3
EZ
4259lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4260"Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4261description of aspects specific to the Mac.
d9c9b920 4262
efeb796b
EZ
4263** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4264new display features described below.
4265
05197f40 4266\f
1fa28578
GM
4267* Changes in Emacs 21.1
4268
1e7db2e9
GM
4269** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4270
4271The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4272Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4273oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4274of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4275the text.
4276
4277** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4278
4279The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4280font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4281height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4282These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4283specify a font.
4284
4285Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4286These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4287under Lisp changes, below.
4288
4289** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4290
4291Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4292Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4293the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4294italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4295Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4296attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4297on terminals.
4298
4299The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4300supported on character terminals.
4301
efeb796b
EZ
4302Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4303the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4304same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4305a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4306
1e7db2e9
GM
4307** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4308
efeb796b
EZ
4309** Sound support
4310
4311Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4312driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4313supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
c8682017
EZ
4314You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4315sound support.
efeb796b 4316
1e7db2e9
GM
4317** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4318
4319If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4320longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4321is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4322minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4323
4324- User option: max-mini-window-height
4325
4326Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4327fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4328specifies a number of lines.
4329
4330Default is 0.25.
4331
4332- User option: resize-mini-windows
4333
4334How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4335resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4336grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4337again.
4338
4339Default is `grow-only'.
4340
4341** LessTif support.
4342
4343Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
a04c6760 4344<http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
1e7db2e9
GM
4345
4346** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4347
4348When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4349from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4350non-nil.
4351
8f80abd8
EZ
4352** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4353
4354When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4355now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4356file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4357
1e7db2e9
GM
4358** Toolkit scroll bars.
4359
4360Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4361LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4362configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4363bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4364bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4365Emacs.
4366
4367When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4368Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4369Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4370Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4371define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4372`s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4373
4374Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4375a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4376directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4377different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4378system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4379add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4380
4381The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4382`float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4383This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3593c177 4384imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
1e7db2e9
GM
4385Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4386
1e7db2e9
GM
4387** Tool bar support.
4388
4389Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4390of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4391changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4392displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4393if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4394icons will be used.
4395
4396To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
70fae708 4397for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
1e7db2e9 4398
1e7db2e9
GM
4399** Tooltips.
4400
4401Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4402mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4403turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4404
4405Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4406variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4407the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4408tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4409
efeb796b
EZ
4410** Automatic Hscrolling
4411
4412Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4413`automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4414customized.
4415
4416If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4417scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4418for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4419the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4420to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4421
1e7db2e9
GM
4422** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4423of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4424solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
ab9c49cf 4425`cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
1e7db2e9 4426cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
2018166d 4427non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
1e7db2e9
GM
4428
4429** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4430truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4431foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4432customizing face `fringe'.
4433
4434** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4435You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4436In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4437appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4438occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4439the window to be partially obscured.)
4440
4441The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
46ff99c0
MB
4442versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4443However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4444ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
1e7db2e9 4445
1e7db2e9
GM
4446** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4447
6b9572dc
EZ
4448Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4449systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4450mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4451mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4452displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4453have enabled one.
1e7db2e9
GM
4454
4455Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4456
3aa2f38a 4457- Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
1e7db2e9 4458
3aa2f38a 4459- Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
1e7db2e9
GM
4460
4461- Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4462`*') toggles the status.
4463
4464- Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4465
1e7db2e9
GM
4466** Hourglass pointer
4467
4468Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4469turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4470
1e7db2e9
GM
4471** Blinking cursor
4472
4473M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4474terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4475and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4476the group `cursor'.
4477
1e7db2e9
GM
4478** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4479
4480This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4481generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4482See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4483details.
4484
4485Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4486have to do anything to activate it.
4487
efeb796b
EZ
4488** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4489
4490The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4491determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4492
4493On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4494according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4495key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4496option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4497delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4498keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4499keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4500set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4501
4502If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4503a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4504Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4505`keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4506the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4507terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4508
4509Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4510to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4511
1e7db2e9
GM
4512** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4513changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4514buffer by default.
4515
4516** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4517current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4518beginning and end of the buffer.
4519
4520** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4521recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4522signaled.
4523
4524** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4525file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4526
1e7db2e9
GM
4527** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4528compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4529this behavior.
4530
efeb796b 4531The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
1e7db2e9
GM
4532compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4533Emacs dump core.
4534
4535** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4536
4537When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4538widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4539Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4540
4541** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4542more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4543now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4544
4545** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4546using that menu.
4547
1e7db2e9
GM
4548** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4549
4550When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4551whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4552defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4553highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4554displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4555whitespace.
4556
1e7db2e9
GM
4557** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4558all frames except the selected one.
4559
4560** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4561let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4562
1e7db2e9
GM
4563** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4564header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4565so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4566This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4567`Info-use-header-line'.
4568
1e7db2e9
GM
4569** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4570have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4571`de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4572
4573** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4574
4575** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4576`dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4577`fr-drdref.tex'.
4578
1e7db2e9
GM
4579** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4580displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4581menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4582menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4583
efeb796b 4584** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
17851d9d 4585
a19e85cc 4586You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
17851d9d
EZ
4587because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4588use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4589`~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
1e7db2e9 4590
1e7db2e9
GM
4591** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4592point in a pop-up window.
4593
1e7db2e9
GM
4594** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4595under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4596customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4597
4598The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4599determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4600
1e7db2e9
GM
4601** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4602sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4603(On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
aa082854 4604You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
1e7db2e9 4605
1e7db2e9
GM
4606** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4607
eb1b0c74
GM
4608** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4609to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4610
c607d53d 4611** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
346598f1 4612trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
c607d53d
SS
4613this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4614
4104194e 4615** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
1e36ff68
DL
4616be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4617non-nil.
4104194e 4618
ba9eeda1
GM
4619** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4620set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4621file that is already visited under a different name.
4622
42ac0ae5
GM
4623** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4624nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
4625
ba9eeda1 4626** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
eb27839a 4627and displays information about that.
b941a14b 4628
25ad1371
GM
4629** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
4630expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
4631
4632This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
4633determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
4634mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
4635interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
4636regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
4637associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
4638
40e857ea 4639** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
424d8b44 4640suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
40e857ea 4641
c08398de
DL
4642** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
4643buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
4644contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
4645by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
4646insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
4647the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
4648Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
4649
efeb796b
EZ
4650** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
4651been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
4652
efeb796b
EZ
4653** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
4654system for keyboard input.
4655
3d6cd763
GM
4656** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
4657coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
4658escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
4659such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
4660recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
07b14857 4661always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3d6cd763 4662read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
07b14857
KH
4663(`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
4664RET C-x C-f filename RET.
26ae8525 4665
0b8a3a6d
DL
4666** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
4667environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
4668
0b8a3a6d
DL
4669** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
4670displays all characters in that character set.
4671
4672** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
4673coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
4674
efeb796b
EZ
4675** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
4676and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
4677LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
4678
efeb796b
EZ
4679** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
4680Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
46818859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
4682GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
46838859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
4684There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
4685and Polish `slash'.
4686
efeb796b
EZ
4687** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
4688These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
4689of the tutorial.
4690
4691** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
4692function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
4693Lisp Coding Convention".
4694
4695 new command old-binding
4696 --- ------- -----------
4697 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
4698 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
4699 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
4700
4701 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4702 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4703 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4704
4705 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4706 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4707 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4708 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4709 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4710 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4711
bd161121
EZ
4712** There are new Leim input methods.
4713New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4714"greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4715package.
4716
efeb796b
EZ
4717** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4718rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4719typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4720"=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4721"`", you must type "=q".
4722
efeb796b
EZ
4723** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
47248859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4725more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4726empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4727window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4728on.
4729
efeb796b
EZ
4730** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4731on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4732defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4733commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5cb6a58e 4734
5898e075
DL
4735** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4736`display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4737indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4738indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4739
cc181e95
GM
4740** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4741on the display using several methods
4742
4743- By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4744a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4745be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4746
4747- By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5820dead 4748equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
cc181e95 4749
da4496b6 4750- By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
cc181e95
GM
4751
4752- By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4753the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4754
3b4fa1b2 4755** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
1c459486 4756an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
3b4fa1b2 4757command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
1c459486 4758does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
0daee095 4759
176256a1 4760** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
3bbc50af
DL
4761`make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
4762typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
176256a1 4763
dd0add8e
DL
4764** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
4765characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
4766
699238d9 4767** New X resources recognized
100b3cbb 4768
7233c5bd
GM
4769*** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
4770whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
4771is useful for debugging X problems.
4772
4773Example:
4774
699238d9 4775 emacs.synchronous: true
7233c5bd 4776
100b3cbb
GM
4777*** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
4778visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
4779the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
4780and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
4781visual class names are
4782
4783 TrueColor
4784 PseudoColor
4785 DirectColor
4786 StaticColor
4787 GrayScale
4788 StaticGray
4789
4790Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
4791`pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
4792meaning.
4793
4794The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
4795supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
4796`visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
4797visual.
4798
4799Example:
4800
699238d9 4801 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
100b3cbb
GM
4802
4803*** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
4804specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
4805default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
4806resource values are `true' or `on'.
4807
4808Example:
4809
699238d9 4810 emacs.privateColormap: true
100b3cbb 4811
a933dad1
DL
4812** Faces and frame parameters.
4813
4814There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
4815Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
4816`scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
4817`scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
4818sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
4819for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
4820parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
4821
4822Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
4823`default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
79214ddf 4824`foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
a933dad1
DL
4825`default' face and vice versa.
4826
f77a4a8a
GM
4827** New face `menu'.
4828
4829The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
f77a4a8a 4830
a933dad1
DL
4831** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
4832
4833The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
4834colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
4835correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
4836the screen gamma of a frame's display.
4837
4838PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
4839in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
4840color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
4841
4842The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
4843`ScreenGamma'.
4844
a933dad1
DL
4845** Tabs and variable-width text.
4846
4847Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
4848defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
4849independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
4850Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
4851
4852** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
4853
4854*** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
4855
4856 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
4857
79dd1637
RS
4858The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
4859LessTif/Motif one.
a933dad1 4860
79dd1637
RS
4861*** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
4862LessTif and Motif.
a933dad1 4863
a933dad1
DL
4864** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
4865
4866As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
4867drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
4868`x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
4869
4870** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
efeb796b 4871bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
a933dad1
DL
4872
4873This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
4874`indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
4875variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
4876
4877** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
4878
4879When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
d9e66103 4880value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 4881number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 4882fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
a933dad1
DL
4883
4884When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
8a33023e 4885value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 4886number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 4887fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
a933dad1 4888
efeb796b
EZ
4889** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
4890M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
4891M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
4892buffers.
4893
4894** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
4895
4896** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
4897abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
4898`directory-abbrev-alist'.
4899
efeb796b
EZ
4900** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
4901the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
4902forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
4903value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
4904users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
4905even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
4906
4907The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
4908
a933dad1
DL
4909** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
4910notably at the end of lines.
4911
4912All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
4913spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
4914
8748ecc0 4915** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
eee54b0e 4916
8748ecc0
GM
4917** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
4918but inserts text instead of replacing it.
2ce72bfa 4919
a933dad1
DL
4920** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
4921query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
4922after each match to get the replacement text.
4923
d5483ab1
GM
4924** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
4925you edit the replacement string.
4ff40dd0 4926
75823f67
EZ
4927** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
4928(if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
4929in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4ff40dd0 4930
efeb796b 4931** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
889be0a1 4932
efeb796b
EZ
4933** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
4934to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
327652be 4935
efeb796b
EZ
4936** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
4937the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
4938MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
4939displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
a32da22c 4940
75823f67 4941--
efeb796b
EZ
4942** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
4943read mail from the menu etc.
559cee90 4944
efeb796b
EZ
4945** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
4946This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
4947MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
4948before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
559cee90 4949
efeb796b
EZ
4950** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
4951MS-DOS version of Emacs.
424d8b44 4952
efeb796b
EZ
4953** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
4954of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
4955This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
4956correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
4957but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
4958of Emacs.
eb2aac9d 4959
efeb796b 4960** Customize changes
eb2aac9d 4961
efeb796b
EZ
4962*** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
4963`State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
4964M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
4965customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
4966earlier versions of Emacs.
1b24b888 4967
efeb796b
EZ
4968*** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
4969Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
4970default).
79c78e77 4971
efeb796b
EZ
4972*** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4973does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
4974file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
4975wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
4976file.
79c78e77 4977
7e97c157
EZ
4978** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4979does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
4980avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
4981already in your init file.
4982
efeb796b 4983** New features in evaluation commands
3476b54a 4984
efeb796b
EZ
4985*** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
4986modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
4987print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
4988customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
4989eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
a933dad1 4990
f37e8c77
EZ
4991The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
4992respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
4993the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
4994the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
4995printed).
4996
75c5350a
GM
4997<RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4998printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
f6e6cdf2 4999
f37e8c77
EZ
5000The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5001during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5002
3a426197 5003*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5e03eb84
GM
5004code when called with a prefix argument.
5005
b1c609b1
GM
5006** CC mode changes.
5007
5008Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5009current user setups (although it's believed that these
5010incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5011However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5012back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5013compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5014release.
5015
e120bebf
GM
5016*** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5017CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5018is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5019confusion.
5020
5021However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5022default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5023java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5024notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5025
5026*** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5027Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5028
5029space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5030parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5031
5032compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5033parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5034It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5035style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5036
5037*** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5038Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5039"electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5040earlier statement. An example:
5041
5042for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5043 if (a[i])
5044 res += a[i]->offset;
5045else
5046
5047Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5048continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5049the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5050possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5051the preceding "if".
5052
5053CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5054by default.
5055
5056*** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5057Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5058meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5059documentation or other natural language text.
5060
5061The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5062contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5063the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5064strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5065to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5066commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5067sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5068
5069*** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5070Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5071source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5072comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5073
5074*** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5075When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5076line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5077change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5078Pike mode only.
5079
5080*** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5081The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5082improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5083stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5084following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5085matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5086indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5087is reported afterwards.
5088
5089*** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5090A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5091returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5092
5093*** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5094Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5095on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5096can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5097code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5098modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5099groundwork.
5100
7972fcfc
GM
5101*** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5102This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5103of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5104non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5105want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5106have to bother.
5107
5108Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5109situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
487522fe 5110and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
7972fcfc
GM
5111If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5112the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5113by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5114
b1c609b1
GM
5115*** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5116When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5117variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5118take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5119is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5120settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5121possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5122Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5123
5124By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5125special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5126the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5127of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5128above.
5129
5130Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5131when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5132function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5133call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5134then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5135values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5136only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5137function documentation for more info.
5138
5139The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5140especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5141with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5142intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5143such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5144is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5145configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5146global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5147
5148(Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5149
5150**** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5151This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5152
5153This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5154variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5155completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5156the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5157empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5158style system.
5159
5160**** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5161In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5162c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5163as far as possible.
5164
5165*** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5166CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5167surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5168chapter about this in the manual.
5169
5170**** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5171The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5172recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5173primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5174adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5175
5176**** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5177This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5178c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5179
5180**** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5181This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5182
5183It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5184Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5185A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5186inside CC Mode.
5187
5188Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5189causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5190the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5191available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5192cc-mode/).
5193
9ed462b7
EZ
5194**** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5195`c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5196enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5197function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5198they were before the filling.
5199
b1c609b1
GM
5200**** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5201The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5202specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5203literals.
5204
5205**** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5206It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5207prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5208you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5209this function.
5210
5211*** Fixes to IDL mode.
5212It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5213to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5214struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5215Thanks to Eric Eide.
5216
5217*** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5218It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5219opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5220
5221**** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5222
5223*** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5224See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5225better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5226and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5227
5228*** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5229previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5230the column specified by comment-column.
5231
5232*** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5233In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5234is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5235prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5236contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5237don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5238
5239*** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5240instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5241arguments.
5242
5243*** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5244
5245*** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5246c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5247c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5248variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5249Provan).
5250
5251*** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5252
efeb796b 5253** Dired changes
c407c570 5254
efeb796b
EZ
5255*** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5256command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5257is, delete only empty directories.
c407c570 5258
efeb796b
EZ
5259*** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5260command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5261copy directories recursively.
87be76f6 5262
efeb796b
EZ
5263*** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5264in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5265the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
3353ef5a 5266
efeb796b
EZ
5267*** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5268replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5269directory.
c407c570 5270
a320a8e7 5271*** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
efeb796b
EZ
5272a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5273This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5274will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5275accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5276
5277*** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5278from ls switches.
5279
5280*** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5281of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5282which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5283source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
a933dad1 5284
efeb796b 5285** Gnus changes.
87be76f6 5286
efeb796b
EZ
5287The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5288four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5289internationalization and mail-fetching.
87be76f6 5290
efeb796b
EZ
5291*** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5292many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
87be76f6 5293
efeb796b 5294If you used procmail like in
87be76f6 5295
efeb796b
EZ
5296(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5297(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5298(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5299(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
35384f06 5300
efeb796b 5301this now has changed to
87be76f6 5302
efeb796b
EZ
5303(setq mail-sources
5304 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5305 :suffix ".in")))
d7b511c4 5306
efeb796b
EZ
5307More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5308Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
d67f47e4 5309
efeb796b
EZ
5310*** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5311Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5312Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5313longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
d7b511c4 5314
efeb796b
EZ
5315The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5316use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5317installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
9d453139 5318
efeb796b
EZ
5319*** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5320parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5321are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5322now just a compatibility layer.
4b9347b3 5323
75823f67
EZ
5324*** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5325Gnus facilities.
5326
efeb796b
EZ
5327*** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5328called to position point.
4b9347b3 5329
efeb796b
EZ
5330*** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5331summary buffers and NOV files.
79214ddf 5332
efeb796b
EZ
5333*** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5334of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
79214ddf 5335
efeb796b
EZ
5336*** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5337subtly different manner.
aca0be23 5338
efeb796b
EZ
5339*** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5340and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5341ever-changing layouts.
79214ddf 5342
efeb796b 5343*** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
79214ddf 5344
efeb796b 5345*** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
8c463abe 5346
efeb796b 5347** Changes in Texinfo mode.
8c463abe 5348
efeb796b
EZ
5349*** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5350macros
79214ddf 5351
efeb796b
EZ
5352 Key binding Macro
5353 -------------------------
5354 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5355 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5356 C-c C-c u @uref
5357 C-c C-c q @quotation
5358 C-c C-c m @email
5359 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5360 M-RET @item
79214ddf 5361
efeb796b 5362*** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
79214ddf 5363
efeb796b 5364** Changes in Outline mode.
79214ddf 5365
efeb796b
EZ
5366There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5367`outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5368the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
89d57763 5369
efeb796b 5370** Changes to Emacs Server
79214ddf 5371
efeb796b
EZ
5372*** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5373with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5374are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5375Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5376buffers to kill, as before.
79214ddf 5377
efeb796b
EZ
5378Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5379i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5380this way.
5381
5382** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5383of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5384
5385** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5386
5387*** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5388The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5389use. Default is 1000.
79214ddf 5390
efeb796b
EZ
5391** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5392groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
f6737cde 5393
efeb796b 5394** Changes to hideshow.el
3f6e4b8b 5395
efeb796b 5396*** Generalized block selection and traversal
f6737cde 5397
efeb796b
EZ
5398A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5399and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5400serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5401See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
f6737cde 5402
efeb796b
EZ
5403*** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5404hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5405be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5406the open block.
f6737cde 5407
efeb796b
EZ
5408*** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5409function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5410the normal block-hiding function.
f6737cde 5411
efeb796b 5412*** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
f6737cde 5413
efeb796b
EZ
5414*** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5415roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5416for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5417for `hs-minor-mode'.
f6737cde 5418
efeb796b
EZ
5419*** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5420hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
f6737cde 5421
efeb796b 5422** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
f6737cde 5423
efeb796b
EZ
5424*** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5425an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5426log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
0c68ce6f 5427
efeb796b
EZ
5428**** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5429current buffer.
d521e087 5430
efeb796b
EZ
5431*** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5432in a log file.
1e7db2e9 5433
efeb796b
EZ
5434*** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5435entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5436Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5437version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5438`change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5439Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5440
5441*** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5442
5443** Changes to cmuscheme
5444
5445*** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5446`cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5447
5448** Changes in Font Lock
5449
5450*** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5451font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5452
5453*** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5454set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5455
5456*** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5457the face used for each string/comment.
5458
5459*** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5460Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5461
5462** Changes to Shell mode
5463
5464*** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5465to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5466non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5467prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5468
5469** Comint (subshell) changes
5470
5471These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5472include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5473
5474*** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5475Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5476BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5477beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5478respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5479the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5480
5481*** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5482to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5483parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5484user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5485this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5486respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5487feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5488`comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5489
5490*** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5491and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5492
5493*** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5494buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5495buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5496
5497The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5498M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5499the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5500
5501*** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5502and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5503see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5504
5505*** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5506saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5507argument, it appends to the file.
5508
5509*** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5510(usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5511compatibility.
5512
5513*** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5514ring (history).
5515
5516*** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5517identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5518strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5519
5520** Changes to Rmail mode
5521
5522*** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5523set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5524receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5525recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5526`user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5527as correspondent.
5528
5529Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5530mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5531regexp matching your mail addresses.
5532
5533*** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5534to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5535Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5536with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5537for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5538
5539*** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5540like `j'.
5541
5542*** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5543specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5544digest message.
5545
5546*** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5547in which folder to put messages automatically.
5548
5549*** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5550with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5551due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5552
5553** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5554an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5555
75823f67
EZ
5556** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5557use the -f option when sending mail.
5558
f68113db
EZ
5559** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5560current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5561the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5562This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5563by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5564displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5565
5566If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5567other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5568`rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5569
efeb796b
EZ
5570** Changes to TeX mode
5571
5572*** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5573`latex-mode'.
5574
5575*** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5576
5577*** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5578
5579*** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5580
5581** Changes to RefTeX mode
5582
5583*** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5584 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5585 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5586 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5587 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5588 can be edited from that buffer.
5589
5590*** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5591 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5592 `A' to use all marked entries).
5593
5594*** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5595 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5596
5597*** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5598 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5599 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5600 been cited.
5601
5602** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5603The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5604semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5605in column 1 are always made leaves.
5606
5607** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5608has the following new features:
5609
5610*** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5611may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5612to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5613time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5614
5615*** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5616feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5617file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5618compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5619pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5620defaults to 1.
5621
5622** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5623file names.
5624
5625** Ispell changes
fbc164de 5626
efeb796b
EZ
5627*** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
5628transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
5629spell-checks the current buffer.
59c1bf85 5630
efeb796b
EZ
5631*** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
5632added.
732b9cdd 5633
efeb796b
EZ
5634*** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
5635correction is made and re-checked.
b8b2ea31 5636
4cdf4bde 5637*** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
b8b2ea31 5638
efeb796b
EZ
5639*** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
5640cases.
b8b2ea31 5641
efeb796b
EZ
5642*** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
5643on syntax errors.
5644
5645*** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
5646end of the buffer.
5647
5648*** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5649
efeb796b
EZ
5650** Makefile mode changes
5651
5652*** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
b8b2ea31 5653
efeb796b
EZ
5654*** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
5655Fontlock mode is active.
1e406be0 5656
efeb796b 5657** Isearch changes
e33b0397 5658
efeb796b
EZ
5659*** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5660so that searches can be resumed.
e33b0397 5661
3a426197 5662*** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
efeb796b
EZ
5663respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
5664that started the search.
5665
5666*** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
5667selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6f8ea2ae 5668
efeb796b 5669*** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
c0510d27 5670
efeb796b
EZ
5671Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
5672`isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
5673search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
5674before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
5675highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
5676`secondary-selection'.
5d94f558 5677
efeb796b
EZ
5678The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
5679will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
5680Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
5681using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
5682usual snappy response.
dc28878c 5683
efeb796b
EZ
5684If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
5685matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
5686set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
5687isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
95931eb1 5688
54baed30
GM
5689** VC Changes
5690
5691VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
5692easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
5693Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
5694to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
5695changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
60a441a5 5696`vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
54baed30
GM
5697version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
5698each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
5699file is registered in that backend.
5700
5701When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5702backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5703directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5704master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5705the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5706As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5707
5708The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5709still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5710RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5711vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5712where it doesn't make sense.)
5713
5714The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5715obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5716`CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5717
5718*** General Changes
5719
5720The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5721checks are always done now.
5722
327652be 5723VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
54baed30
GM
5724operations.
5725
c286608e
SM
5726`vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5727`vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5728`vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5729
22933be8
AS
5730The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5731first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5732current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5733the working file (``merge news'').
5734
5735The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5736(vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5737downwards.
5738
5739*** Multiple Backends
5740
5741VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5742useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5743repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5744commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5745local RCS archives.
5746
5747To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5748should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5749backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5750`vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5751
60a441a5
AS
5752You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5753C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5754a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5755if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5756current revision number from the more remote backend.
22933be8
AS
5757
5758If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
5759another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
5760any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
5761pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
5762
5763After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
5764changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
5765local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
5766buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
5767
54baed30
GM
5768*** Changes for CVS
5769
5770There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
5771default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
5772remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
5773by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
5774regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
5775that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
5776queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
5777
22933be8
AS
5778If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
5779repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
5780revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
5781any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
5782backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
5783number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
5784(vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
5785of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
5786the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
105602b1
EZ
5787automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
5788since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
5789name.)
22933be8 5790
54baed30
GM
5791If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
5792repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
5793If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
22933be8 5794commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
54baed30
GM
5795current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
5796entire directory tree.
5797
5798The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
5799"cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
5800is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
5801"watched" by other developers.)
5802
22933be8
AS
5803The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5804(vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
60a441a5 5805an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
22933be8
AS
5806starting at the given directory.
5807
54baed30
GM
5808*** Lisp Changes in VC
5809
5810VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
5811add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
5812library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
5813then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
60a441a5
AS
5814a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
5815provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
54baed30 5816of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
60a441a5
AS
5817you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
5818`SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
54baed30 5819
c4ed232b 5820** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
732b9cdd
GM
5821SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
5822terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
5823See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
5824
a933dad1
DL
5825** New modes and packages
5826
79b9f6e0
MB
5827*** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
5828automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
5829the default is not applicable.
5830
b95b34e5
GM
5831*** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
5832rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
5833shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
5834
5835Features are:
5836
5837- Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
5838 drawn, like this: | \ /
c607d53d 5839 --+-- X
b95b34e5
GM
5840 | / \
5841
5842- Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
5843 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
5844 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
5845 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
5846 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
5847 you are drawing.
5848
5849- Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
5850 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
5851
5852- Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
5853 flood-filling.
5854
5855- Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
5856 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
5857 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
5858 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
c607d53d 5859
b95b34e5
GM
5860- Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
5861 also do without the mouse.
5862
5863- Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
5864 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
5865 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
5866 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
5867 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
5868
5869- Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
5870
5871 lines straight-lines
5872 rectangles squares
5873 poly-lines straight poly-lines
5874 ellipses circles
5875 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
5876 spray-can setting size for spraying
5877 vaporize line vaporize lines
5878 erase characters erase rectangles
5879
5880 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
5881 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
5882 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
5883 drawing.
5884
5885 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
5886 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
5887 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
5888 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
5889
5890- Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
5891 can be turned off).
5892
4473cdd9
JW
5893*** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
5894implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
5895It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
5896functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
5897history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
5898will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
5899the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
5900rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
5901all within the scope of your Emacs process.
5902
90cbf47e
GM
5903*** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
5904intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
5905typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
5906on certain projects.
5907
baf7eee4
GM
5908*** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
5909of interactively entered regexps. For example,
abb2db1c 5910
d96d6bb0 5911 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
abb2db1c
GM
5912
5913will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
5914face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
5915typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
5916Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
5917appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
5918current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
baf7eee4
GM
5919corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
5920to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
abb2db1c 5921
d96d6bb0 5922*** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
abb2db1c
GM
5923Emacs is idle.
5924
b4c3513f
EZ
5925*** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
5926fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
5927
31fc5d15
GM
5928*** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
5929parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
5930
5cb6a58e
SM
5931*** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
5932package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
5933be more robust while offering the same functionality.
601e0081
SM
5934`comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
5935comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5cb6a58e 5936
578979ee
GM
5937*** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
5938facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
5939separate Texinfo file.
5940
424d8b44
DL
5941*** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
5942by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
5943provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
5944`log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
8a33023e 5945enter check-in log messages.
dc1178bf 5946
6abca616
EZ
5947*** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
5948without invoking external programs.
5949
5950The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
5951and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
5952`manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
5953is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
490f2e7b 5954Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6abca616
EZ
5955
5956The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
5957page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
5958
5e5dff44
GM
5959*** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
5960authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
5961
5962The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
5963the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
5964the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
5965Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
5966even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
5967single step.
5968
5969On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
5970matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
5971probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
5972contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
5973
f7136ee8
GM
5974*** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
5975unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
5976actually modifying content of a buffer.
5977
bbd9b566
GM
5978*** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
5979PostScript.
5980
5981Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
5982
5983The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
5984
5985 ; comment (until end of line)
5986 A non-terminal
5987 "C" terminal
5988 ?C? special
5989 $A default non-terminal
5990 $"C" default terminal
5991 $?C? default special
5992 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
5993 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
5994 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
5995 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
5996 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5997 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5998 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5999 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6000 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6001 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6002 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6003 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6004 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6005 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6006 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6007
6008Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6009
99453a38
GM
6010*** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6011align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6012determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6013example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6014equal signs of assignments.
6015
559cee90
DL
6016*** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6017paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6018
6448a6b3
GM
6019*** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6020list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
2018166d 6021buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6448a6b3 6022
6344985d
GM
6023*** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6024
249652b1
GM
6025*** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6026replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6027is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6028and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6029not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6030which answers different needs.
6031
3476b54a
GM
6032*** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6033suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6034expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6035course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6036reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6037to be enabled.
6038
8964fec7
SM
6039*** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6040containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6041
a933dad1
DL
6042*** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6043
16837afc
GM
6044*** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6045current line in the current buffer. It also provides
dfd67a62 6046`global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
a933dad1
DL
6047
6048*** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6049
fba448c1 6050Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
8901d1ac
GM
6051`global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6052disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6053`comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6054displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6055and background colors.
6056
a933dad1
DL
6057*** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6058Pascal) language.
6059
6060*** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6061the text at point.
6062
6063*** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6064
8d54eb69
DL
6065*** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6066
732b9cdd
GM
6067*** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6068whitespace in a file.
a933dad1 6069
ebcfda83
GM
6070*** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6071files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6072(very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6073interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6074often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6075uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6076codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6077
6078*** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6079
6080Here is an example of columns:
6081
6082horse apple bus
6083dog pineapple car EXTRA
6084porcupine strawberry airplane
6085
6086Doing the following settings:
6087
6088 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6089 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6090 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6091 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6092
6093
6094Selecting the lines above and typing:
6095
6096 M-x delimit-columns-region
6097
6098It results:
6099
6100[ horse , apple , bus , ]
6101[ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6102[ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6103
6104delim-col has the following options:
6105
6106 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6107 before all columns.
6108
6109 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6110 between each column.
6111
6112 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6113 after all columns.
6114
6115 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6116 each column.
6117
6118delim-col has the following commands:
6119
6120 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6121 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6122
2018166d
DL
6123*** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6124operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6125menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6126recent file list can be displayed:
f507826c 6127
31fc5d15 6128- organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
8a33023e
GM
6129- sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6130- showing paths relative to the current default-directory
f507826c 6131
31fc5d15
GM
6132The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6133dynamically change the menu appearance.
f507826c 6134
8062f458
DL
6135*** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6136text.
6137
36e24b82 6138*** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
91735437
DL
6139of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6140specific to Message mode.
6141
36e24b82
DL
6142*** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6143viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6144with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6145
aaa659ef
DL
6146*** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6147interface to access directory servers using different directory
6148protocols. It has a separate manual.
6149
eee54b0e
DL
6150*** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6151for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6152
612839b6
GM
6153*** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6154
5d94f558 6155*** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
612839b6 6156minibuffer with completion.
aaa659ef 6157
399da7e3
DL
6158*** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6159with the diary features.
6160
6e417ca5
DL
6161*** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6162numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6163
4a27bdfb
GM
6164*** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6165Fill mode.
6166
dace60cf
JW
6167*** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6168facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6169difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6170they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
a18a342d 6171
9540ec3f
EZ
6172*** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6173It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6174`.g'.
6175
efeb796b
EZ
6176** Changes in sort.el
6177
6178The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6179as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6180new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6181numeric base.
6182
6183** Changes to Ange-ftp
6184
efeb796b
EZ
6185*** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6186names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6187sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6188
6189*** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6190ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6191
6192*** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6193output ^M at the end of lines.
6194
efeb796b
EZ
6195** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6196mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6197
efeb796b
EZ
6198** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6199If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6200`(msb-mode 1)'.
6201
6202** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6203group.
6204
6205** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6206behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6207are recognized:
6208
6209`untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6210`hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6211`all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6212nil -- just delete one character.
6213
6214Default value is `untabify'.
6215
6216[This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6217
6218** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6219symbol, not double-quoted.
6220
6221** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6222version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6223profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6224moved to lisp/obsolete.
6225
6226** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6227To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6228`auto-compression-mode' command.
6229
6230** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6231`browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6232`browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6233
6234** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6235`browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6236
efeb796b
EZ
6237** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6238operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6239
efeb796b
EZ
6240** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6241is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6242
6243** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6244support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6245use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6246buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6247M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6248new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6249
efeb796b
EZ
6250** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6251a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6252
6253** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6254
6255The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6256file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6257
6258** Shell script mode changes.
6259
6260Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6261derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6262sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6263
6264** Etags changes.
6265
6266*** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6267
6268*** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6269possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6270{lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6271This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6272a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6273
6274*** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6275declarations when given the --declarations option.
6276
6277*** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6278"operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6279
6280*** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6281automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6282`template' keywords.
6283
6284*** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6285C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6286
6287*** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6288types.
6289
6290*** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6291
6292*** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6293
6294*** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6295are now tagged.
6296
6297*** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6298
6299*** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6300variables are tagged.
6301
6302*** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6303
6304*** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6305for PSWrap.
6306
efeb796b
EZ
6307** Changes in etags.el
6308
6309*** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6310tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6311is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6312
6313*** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6314the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6315
6316If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6317FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6318TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6319obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6320
6321TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6322
6323FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6324List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6325
6326A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6327
6328 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6329 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6330 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6331
6332*** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6333of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6334
6335*** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6336names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6337
6338*** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6339If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6340/tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6341"dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6342point will go to the beginning of the file.
6343
6344*** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6345auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6346(with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6347
6348*** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6349in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6350found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6351
efeb796b
EZ
6352** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6353remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6354appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6355
6356** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6357
efeb796b
EZ
6358** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6359
efeb796b
EZ
6360** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6361containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6362expression from that list, are not checked.
6363
6364** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6365When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6366and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6367the buffer, just like for the local files.
6368
6369** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6370
efeb796b
EZ
6371** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6372displays local abbrevs, only.
6373
965bc065
DL
6374** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6375paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6376
4e8864c7
GM
6377** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6378may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6379is measured in pixels.
6380
965bc065
DL
6381** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6382to be visited as images.
6383
68d0efa6
GM
6384** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6385were added to compile.el.
6386
a933dad1
DL
6387** Withdrawn packages
6388
6389*** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6390functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
25a81338 6391
3261c1d8
DL
6392*** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6393
6394*** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
ce75fd23 6395
05197f40 6396\f
01242779
DL
6397* Incompatible Lisp changes
6398
6399There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6400may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
3b6936cc 6401See the sections below for details.
01242779 6402
89d57763 6403** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
9b2a085d 6404`(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
bd1190d7
RS
6405Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6406to remove the properties of the copy.
01242779
DL
6407
6408** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6409which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6410may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6411these properties are active.
6412
4dd4cc14 6413** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
01242779 6414ranges may affect some code.
1c14ba45
DL
6415
6416** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6417buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6418make a difference to some code.
6419
4dd4cc14
DL
6420** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6421operates on the minibuffer.
6422
7c94ccf6
EZ
6423** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6424cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6425different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6426(previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6427Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6428character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6429multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6430encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6431reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6432sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6433a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6434the buffer as multibyte characters.
6435
6436Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6437MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6438appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6439
7a39158f 6440** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
3280fbe8
EZ
6441`after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6442`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7a39158f
DL
6443
6444** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
539e74f9
EZ
6445long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6446such as `mapconcat'.
7a39158f 6447
55bb62fd
EZ
6448** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6449string.
6450
f34eb373
DL
6451** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6452extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6453dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6454one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6455charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6456the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
028d739a
DL
6457encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6458probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
3478eafc 6459
98384b7b
EZ
6460** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6461Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6462aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6463not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6464on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6465behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6466turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6467remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6468advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6469will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7cd5f1e7 6470
05197f40 6471\f
ce75fd23
GM
6472* Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6473(Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6474
e3b22517
GM
6475** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6476
1ff74324 6477** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
9e5a7f2a
GM
6478allows the animated display of strings.
6479
ed31fabf
GM
6480** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6481interactive form of a function.
6482
2018166d
DL
6483** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6484between custom options. Example:
6485
6486 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6487 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6488 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6489 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6490 :group 'mule
6491 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6492 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6493
6494This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6495current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6496first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6497
f3780fe4 6498** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
a758f97d
GM
6499function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6500args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6501(signal or normal termination).
6502
023045d6
DL
6503** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6504from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6505
eb1b0c74
GM
6506** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6507to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6508
52d89894
GM
6509** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6510alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6511
693c4692 6512** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
4301cf66 6513
6bc92b2e
GM
6514** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6515deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6516being deleted.
6517
39e776cd
SM
6518** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6519
1396138a 6520** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
a18a342d
DL
6521If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6522skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6523with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6524C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6525charset.
6526
4fbdfdcf
MB
6527** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6528the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6529message.
6530
6a0b0752
MB
6531** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6532expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6533
47e351a3
GM
6534** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6535with the more general `:mask' property.
6536
f864120f 6537** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
ba9eeda1 6538
a2bd77b8
GM
6539** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6540backslash.
6541
424d8b44
DL
6542** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6543is running in batch mode. For example,
6544
6545 (message "%s" (read t))
6546
6547will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6548to standard output.
6549
424d8b44
DL
6550** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6551`kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6552
ead53494
GM
6553** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6554will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6555frame or window.
6556
27848c01
GM
6557** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6558were added
6559
6560- Function: remove ELT SEQ
6561
8a33023e 6562Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
27848c01
GM
6563a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6564
6565- Function: remq ELT LIST
6566
8a33023e 6567Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
27848c01
GM
6568comparison is done with `eq'.
6569
6570** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
3ab82477 6571
b548072f 6572** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
c8682017 6573has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
92d2f186 6574`key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
b548072f 6575
07b14857
KH
6576** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6577without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6578convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6579
9662da0b
GM
6580** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6581or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
d5aa31d8 6582
7fce7efb
DL
6583** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6584function was declared obsolete.
6585
5d94f558 6586** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7fce7efb
DL
6587retained as an alias).
6588
593b3517
RS
6589** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
6590the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
f98d3086 6591
87efd256
GM
6592** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6593
39b39373
GM
6594- Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6595
6596Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6597omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6598the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6599even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6600minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6601means never include the minibuffer window.
87efd256 6602
a56ebb90 6603** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
67c9a1d2 6604
a56ebb90 6605- Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
67c9a1d2
GM
6606
6607Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6608
6609This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6610calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6611argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6612value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6613returned.
6614
6615Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6616if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6617it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6618minibuffer even if it is active.
6619
6620Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6621counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6622too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6623and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6624`walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
6625entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
6626
6627ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
6628ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
6629ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
6630ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
6631ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
6632If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
6633Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
6634
ead53494
GM
6635** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
6636event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
6637argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
dce6b995 6638
25fa6deb
GM
6639** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6640call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
088831a6
GM
6641message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
6642Default value is nil.
25fa6deb 6643
5d94f558 6644** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
1681ead6
GM
6645meaning no limit.
6646
5b034b7f
EZ
6647** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
6648the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
6649numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
6650
5d94f558 6651** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
c08398de
DL
6652coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
6653DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
6654
9b2999d0
DL
6655** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
6656list of a primitive.
de370c4c 6657
c286608e
SM
6658** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
6659
80c05bd3
DL
6660** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
6661buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
6662This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
6663than replacing the local map.
6664
14fd0da3
DL
6665** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
6666`after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
6667removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
6668instead.
45f485a6
GM
6669
6670** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
6671
c286608e
SM
6672** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
6673as promised long ago.
f0298744 6674
5d94f558 6675** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
ac57988b
GM
6676
6677** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
6678for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
6679patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
6680
05197f40 6681\f
a933dad1
DL
6682* Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
6683
6260538e
GM
6684** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
6685regular expressions.
6686
6687- Function: rx-to-string SEXP
6688
6689Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6690
6691- Macro: rx SEXP
6692
6693Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6694
6695The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
6696notation.
6697
6698STRING
6699 matches string STRING literally.
6700
6701CHAR
6702 matches character CHAR literally.
6703
6704`not-newline'
6705 matches any character except a newline.
6706 .
6707`anything'
6708 matches any character
6709
6710`(any SET)'
6711 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6712 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6713
79014980 6714'(in SET)'
6260538e
GM
6715 like `any'.
6716
6717`(not (any SET))'
6718 matches any character not in SET
6719
6720`line-start'
6721 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6722 in the text being matched
6723
6724`line-end'
6725 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6726
6727`string-start'
6728 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6729 string being matched against.
6730
6731`string-end'
6732 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6733 string being matched against.
6734
6735`buffer-start'
6736 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6737 buffer being matched against.
6738
6739`buffer-end'
6740 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6741 buffer being matched against.
6742
6743`point'
6744 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6745
6746`word-start'
6747 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6748 word.
6749
6750`word-end'
6751 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6752
6753`word-boundary'
6754 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6755 word.
6756
6757`(not word-boundary)'
6758 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
6759 word.
6760
6761`digit'
6762 matches 0 through 9.
6763
6764`control'
6765 matches ASCII control characters.
6766
6767`hex-digit'
6768 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6769
6770`blank'
6771 matches space and tab only.
6772
6773`graphic'
6774 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6775 space, and DEL.
6776
6777`printing'
6778 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6779 and DEL.
6780
6781`alphanumeric'
6782 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6783 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6784
6785`letter'
6786 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6787 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6788
6789`ascii'
6790 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6791
6792`nonascii'
6793 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6794
6795`lower'
6796 matches anything lower-case.
6797
6798`upper'
6799 matches anything upper-case.
6800
6801`punctuation'
6802 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6803 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6804
6805`space'
6806 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6807
6808`word'
6809 matches anything that has word syntax.
6810
6811`(syntax SYNTAX)'
6812 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
6813 of the following symbols.
6814
6815 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
6816 `punctuation' (\\s.)
6817 `word' (\\sw)
6818 `symbol' (\\s_)
6819 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
6820 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
6821 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
6822 `string-quote' (\\s\")
6823 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
6824 `escape' (\\s\\)
6825 `character-quote' (\\s/)
6826 `comment-start' (\\s<)
6827 `comment-end' (\\s>)
6828
6829`(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
6830 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
6831
6832`(category CATEGORY)'
6833 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
6834 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
6835
6836 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
6837 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
6838 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
6839 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
6840 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
6841 `symbol' (\\c5)
6842 `digit' (\\c6)
6843 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
6844 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
6845 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
6846 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
6847 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
6848 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
6849 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
6850 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
6851 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
175573ac 6852 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6260538e
GM
6853 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
6854 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
6855 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
6856 `ascii' (\\ca)
6857 `arabic' (\\cb)
6858 `chinese' (\\cc)
6859 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
6860 `greek' (\\cg)
6861 `korean' (\\ch)
6862 `indian' (\\ci)
6863 `japanese' (\\cj)
6864 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
6865 `latin' (\\cl)
6866 `lao' (\\co)
6867 `tibetan' (\\cq)
6868 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
6869 `thai' (\\ct)
6870 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
6871 `hebrew' (\\cw)
6872 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
6873 `can-break' (\\c|)
6874
6875`(not (category CATEGORY))'
6876 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
6877
6878`(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6879 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
6880
6881`(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6882 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
6883 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
6884
6885`(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6886 another name for `submatch'.
6887
6888`(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6889 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
6890 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
6891 regular expression.
6892
6893`(minimal-match SEXP)'
6894 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
e0e7f2d5 6895 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6260538e
GM
6896 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
6897 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
6898
6899`(maximal-match SEXP)'
c3518b63 6900 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6260538e
GM
6901
6902`(zero-or-more SEXP)'
6903 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6904
6905`(0+ SEXP)'
6906 like `zero-or-more'.
6907
6908`(* SEXP)'
6909 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6910
6911`(*? SEXP)'
6912 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6913
6914`(one-or-more SEXP)'
6915 matches one or more occurrences of A.
79014980 6916
6260538e
GM
6917`(1+ SEXP)'
6918 like `one-or-more'.
6919
6920`(+ SEXP)'
6921 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6922
6923`(+? SEXP)'
6924 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6925
6926`(zero-or-one SEXP)'
6927 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
79014980 6928
6260538e
GM
6929`(optional SEXP)'
6930 like `zero-or-one'.
6931
6932`(? SEXP)'
6933 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6934
6935`(?? SEXP)'
6936 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6937
6938`(repeat N SEXP)'
6939 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6940
6941`(repeat N M SEXP)'
6942 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6943
6944`(eval FORM)'
c3518b63 6945 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6260538e
GM
6946 `regexp-quote' it.
6947
6948`(regexp REGEXP)'
6949 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
6950
697617d9
GM
6951*** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
6952
85c75536
MB
6953*** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
6954buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
6955the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
6956restriction to be restored incorrectly.
6957
0b8a3a6d
DL
6958*** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
6959`eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
028d739a 6960when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
0b8a3a6d
DL
6961multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
6962
fb2c6a6b 6963*** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
58008c36
EZ
6964`string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
6965if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
0b8a3a6d
DL
6966
6967*** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
6968changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
6969[\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
6970regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
6971the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
6972extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
6973bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
6974eight-bit-graphic.
6975
6976** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
6977
9b2a085d 6978A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
0b8a3a6d
DL
6979a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
6980character set as previously.
6981
6982*** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
6983They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
6984modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
6985
6986CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
6987characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
6988range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
6989case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
6990
6991FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
9b2a085d 6992name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
0b8a3a6d
DL
6993
6994*** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
6995registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6996"fontset-default".
6997
6998*** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6999argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7000
7001** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7002composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7003buffers and strings.
7004
7005*** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7006character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7007code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7008have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7009composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7010composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7011The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7012also been deleted.
7013
7014*** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7015specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7016`reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7017
7018*** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7019MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7020composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7021may differ between buffer and string text.
7022
7023*** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7024COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7025
7026*** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7027directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7028Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7029`composition' from STRING.
7030
7031*** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7032a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7033
7034*** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7035obsolete.
7036
889be0a1
DL
7037** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7038the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7039
965bc065 7040** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
1e36ff68
DL
7041`mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7042introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7043U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
0b8a3a6d 7044
3d7a4ec8
EZ
7045Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7046characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7047etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7048different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7049which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7050encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7051
7052** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7053It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7054details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
23cfab61 7055
0b8a3a6d 7056** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
1e36ff68
DL
7057`japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7058standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7059
7060** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7061have been introduced.
0b8a3a6d 7062
0b8a3a6d 7063** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
1e36ff68 7064have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
028d739a
DL
70650xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7066eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7067emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
2018166d
DL
7068buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7069eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7070must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7071their multibyte equivalent.
0b8a3a6d 7072
f0124b4a
DL
7073** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7074that offset in the file before writing.
7075
f98d3086
SM
7076** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7077compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7464346d 7078
612839b6
GM
7079** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7080`*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7081from which the command was issued.
7082
7083** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7084`query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7085`replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7086additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7087operate on.
7088
271b4185
GM
7089** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7090to `window-buffer-height'.
7091
7092- Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7093
7094Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7095The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7096lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7097
7098Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7099respectively.
7100
8a33023e 7101If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
271b4185
GM
7102COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7103
7104The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7105obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7106on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7107
7108Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7109buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7110possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7111is currently displayed in some window.
7112
3c30cb6e
DL
7113** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7114argument function's results.
7115
62f20204 7116** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
55bb62fd 7117signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
c8682017
EZ
7118`base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
711920, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
55bb62fd 7120sequence).
62f20204 7121
c0510d27 7122** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
b4da8dfa 7123header in the list of headers passed to it.
c0510d27
GM
7124
7125** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7126ignores differences in case and text representation.
7127
7128** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
19d1bc27
GM
7129cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7130as follows:
7131
7132 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7133 nil don't display a cursor
7134 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7135 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7136 others display a box cursor.
7137
9a0dd3dc
GM
7138** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7139an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7140defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7141set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7142
d7b511c4 7143** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
dc1178bf 7144specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
d7b511c4
GM
7145the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7146text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7147
7148Example:
7149
7150 (string-to-syntax "()")
7151 => (4 . 41)
7152
1fa28578
GM
7153** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7154other than 10.
7155
7156*** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7157INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7158
5d94f558 7159 #b1111
1fa28578 7160 => 15
5d94f558 7161 #b-1111
1fa28578
GM
7162 => -15
7163
7164*** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7165
5d94f558 7166 #o666
1fa28578
GM
7167 => 438
7168
7169*** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7170
5d94f558 7171 #xbeef
1fa28578
GM
7172 => 48815
7173
7174*** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7175
5d94f558 7176 #2R-111
1fa28578 7177 => -7
5d94f558 7178 #25rah
1fa28578
GM
7179 => 267
7180
3d4ff2dd 7181** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
f98d3086 7182the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
e9b4e5ff
GM
7183and isn't a string.
7184
3d4ff2dd
GM
7185** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7186a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7187value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7188not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7189
16ce590d
DL
7190** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7191
73825616 7192** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
16ce590d
DL
7193for a regexp in a string.
7194
7195** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7196`mouse-position-function'.
7197
723e779c
GM
7198** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7199that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7200
d1e103b2
GM
7201** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7202Keywords are now always considered constants.
7203
31047e0d
DL
7204** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7205returns it.
7206
7a85e4df
GM
7207** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7208returned by function `recent-keys'.
7209
02b14400
RS
7210** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7211can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
3a426197 7212Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
02b14400
RS
7213etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7214mode.
404fa7d6 7215
8964fec7
SM
7216** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7217and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7218
02b14400
RS
7219** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7220has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7221function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7222returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7223been performed."
7224
7225When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7226and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7227hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7228then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
ef961722 7229
81da8b32
GM
7230** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7231In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7232and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7233
9e207b90
GM
7234** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7235with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7236specified table.
7237
7238 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7239
7240Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
03d9c64c
GM
7241TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7242saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7243what BODY returns.
9e207b90 7244
d7f89643 7245** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
95cd4c40 7246Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8a33023e 7247Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
601e0081
SM
7248corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7249Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8964fec7 7250
dde9e75a
GM
7251** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7252removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7253
9da30515
GM
7254** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7255instead of being optional.
7256
d20679eb
GM
7257** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7258modify read-only text.
7259
fbc164de
PE
7260** New functions and variables for locales.
7261
7262The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7263decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
b718982a
PE
7264time functions like strftime. The new variables
7265`system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7266locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
fbc164de
PE
7267
7268The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7269environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7270the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
b718982a
PE
7271environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7272not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7273`locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7274`locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
fbc164de 7275
863476d1
SM
7276** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7277To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7278modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7279start sequences.
7280
ef6d912c
GM
7281** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7282because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7283
a933dad1
DL
7284** New function `propertize'
7285
7286The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7287strings with text properties.
7288
7289- Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7290
7291Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7292by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7293PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7294specified value of that property. Example:
7295
7296 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7297
a933dad1
DL
7298** push and pop macros.
7299
02b14400
RS
7300Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7301are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
a933dad1
DL
7302as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7303
7304(push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7305(pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7306 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7307
02b14400
RS
7308** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7309
6c7fd5aa
RS
7310Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7311are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
02b14400
RS
7312
7313(dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7314 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7315 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7316 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7317
7318(dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7319 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7320 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7321 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7322
6c083b4c
GM
7323** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7324[:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7325class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7326or a sign.
a933dad1
DL
7327
7328[:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7329[:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7330[:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7331[:blank:] matches space and tab only
7332[:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7333 space, and DEL.
7334[:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7335 and DEL.
7336[:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7337 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7338 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7339[:alpha:] matches letters.
7340 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7341 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7342[:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7343[:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7344[:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7345[:punct:] matches punctuation.
7346 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7347 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7348[:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7349[:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7350[:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7351
a933dad1
DL
7352** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7353
7354The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7355
7356- Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7357
7358The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7359are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7360
7361:test TEST
7362
7363TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7364Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7365it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7366
7367:size SIZE
7368
7369SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7370many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7371
7372:rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7373
7374REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7375full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7376size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
73771.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7378old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7379
7380:rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7381
7382THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7383hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7384(size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7385
7386:weakness WEAK
7387
b548072f
GM
7388WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7389`key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7390`key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7391collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7392outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
a933dad1
DL
7393
7394- Function: makehash &optional TEST
7395
7396Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7397
7398- Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7399
7400Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7401
7402- Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7403
7404Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7405values are shared.
7406
7407- Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7408
7409Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7410
7411- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7412
7413Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7414
7415- Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7416
7417Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7418
7419- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7420
7421Returns the size of TABLE.
7422
d96d6bb0 7423- Function: hash-table-test TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7424
7425Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7426
7427- Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7428
7429Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7430
7431- Function: clrhash TABLE
7432
7433Clear TABLE.
7434
7435- Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7436
7437Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7438not found.
7439
79214ddf 7440- Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7441
7442Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7443another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7444
7445- Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7446
7447Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7448
7449- Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7450
7451Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7452arguments KEY and VALUE.
7453
7454- Function: sxhash OBJ
7455
7456Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7457
7458- Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7459
7460Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7461a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
79214ddf 7462comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
a933dad1
DL
7463and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7464of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7465
7466TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7467
7468HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7469code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7470integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7471
7472Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7473be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7474
7475 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7476 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7477
7478 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7479 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7480
79214ddf 7481 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
a933dad1
DL
7482 'case-fold-string-hash))
7483
7484 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7485
a933dad1
DL
7486** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7487
7488It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7489circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7490a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7491
a933dad1
DL
7492** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7493
7494If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7495#N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7496
a933dad1
DL
7497** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7498t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7499specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7500is too short to reach that column.
7501
a933dad1
DL
7502** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7503now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7504after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7505two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7506
7507If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7508perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7509and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7510
a933dad1
DL
7511** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7512to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7513
a933dad1
DL
7514** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7515calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7516
a933dad1
DL
7517** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7518directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7519small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7520small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7521temporary-file-directory instead.
7522
a933dad1
DL
7523** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7524the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7525`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7526hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7527
2018166d
DL
7528** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7529elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
a933dad1 7530
a933dad1
DL
7531** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7532
7533make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7534creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7535ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7536
a933dad1
DL
7537** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7538
7539The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7540on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7541is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7542never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7543ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7544overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7545
7546If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7547that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7548to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7549The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7550
a933dad1
DL
7551** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7552
7553Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7554If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7555ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7556result string.
7557
7558Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7559string where arguments appear in the result string.
7560
7561Example:
7562
7563 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7564 (s2 "world"))
7565 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7566 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
b246b1f6 7567 (format s1 s2))
a933dad1
DL
7568
7569results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7570
a933dad1
DL
7571** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7572
7573Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7574The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7575argument in it.
7576
7577 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7578 (arg "world"))
7579 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7580 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7581 (message msg arg))
7582
a933dad1
DL
7583** Sound support
7584
7585Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7586(Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7587
7588Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7589(*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7590to enable sound support.
7591
7592Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7593list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7594when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7595functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7596sound to play, before playing the sound.
7597
7598The following sound properties are supported:
7599
7600- `:file FILE'
7601
7602FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7603searched relative to `data-directory'.
7604
6fb40beb
GM
7605- `:data DATA'
7606
7607DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7608may be present, but not both.
7609
a933dad1
DL
7610- `:volume VOLUME'
7611
7612VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
76130..1. This property is optional.
7614
01242779
DL
7615- `:device DEVICE'
7616
7617DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7618sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7619
a933dad1
DL
7620Other properties are ignored.
7621
01242779
DL
7622An alternative interface is called as
7623(play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7624
a933dad1 7625** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
356673d4
DL
7626
7627** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
7628a keyword symbol.
fc91dc2d
GM
7629
7630** Changes to garbage collection
7631
7632*** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
7633of live and free strings.
7634
7635*** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
7636strings that have been consed so far.
7637
05197f40 7638\f
04545643
GM
7639* Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
7640Lisp Manual
7641
a299a6f0
GM
7642** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
7643mini-windows.
7644
26fcde61
MB
7645** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
7646argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
7647returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
ea4c1b7c 7648
a299a6f0 7649** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
82a452c8 7650
9a8d84ca 7651** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
2c69ced2
GM
7652
7653** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
7654image.
7655
7656- Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
7657
7658Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
7659
7660SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
7661measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
7662character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
7663font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
7664FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
7665
ebb8f116
GM
7666** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
7667has a mask bitmap.
7668
7669- Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
7670
7671Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
7672FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
7673or omitted means use the selected frame.
7674
0b8a3a6d
DL
7675** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
7676satisfying one of a list of specifications.
7677
0b8a3a6d
DL
7678** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
7679optional.
7680
f6499c03
DL
7681** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
7682below).
04545643 7683
05197f40 7684\f
a933dad1
DL
7685* New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
7686
f6d3257b
GM
7687** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
7688to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
7689
7690Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
7691text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
7692is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
7693your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
7694laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
7695just display it black instead.
7696
7697This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
7698a line like
7699
7700 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7701
7702in your `.emacs'.
7703
a933dad1
DL
7704** New face implementation.
7705
7706Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7707font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7708
a933dad1
DL
7709*** New faces.
7710
7711Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7712
7713 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
79214ddf 7714
a933dad1
DL
7715 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7716 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
79214ddf 7717
a933dad1 7718 3. Font height in 1/10pt
79214ddf 7719
a933dad1 7720 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
79214ddf 7721
a933dad1 7722 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
79214ddf 7723
a933dad1 7724 6. Foreground color.
79214ddf 7725
a933dad1
DL
7726 7. Background color.
7727
7728 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7729
7730 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7731
7732 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7733
7734 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7735
7736 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7737 color.
7738
7739 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7740 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7741
7742Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7743same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7744frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7745faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
0969bd6a 7746with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
a933dad1
DL
7747attributes mentioned above.
7748
7749There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7750definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7751created frames.
79214ddf 7752
a933dad1
DL
7753A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7754have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7755`fully-specified'.
7756
a933dad1
DL
7757*** Face merging.
7758
7759The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
7760combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
7761aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
7762properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
7763that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
7764results in a fully-specified face.
7765
a933dad1
DL
7766*** Face realization.
7767
7768After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
7769merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
7770realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
7771available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
7772face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
7773cache of the frame on which it was realized.
7774
7775Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
7776character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
7777for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
7778charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
7779
7780Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
7781specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
7782being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
7783the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
7784statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
7785
7786In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
7787`char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
77880x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
7789the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
7790initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
7791Emacs.
7792
7793Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
7794`enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
7795registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
7796with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
7797
a933dad1
DL
7798**** Clearing face caches.
7799
7800The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
7801on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
7802unused fonts.
7803
a933dad1 7804*** Font selection.
79214ddf 7805
a933dad1
DL
7806Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
7807given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
7808for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
7809
7810If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
7811pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
7812family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
7813property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
7814an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
7815
7816Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
7817against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
7818match for the given face attributes in this font list.
7819
7820Font selection can be influenced by the user.
7821
7822The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
7823attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
7824face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
7825names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
7826that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
7827width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
7828to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
7829
52d89894
GM
7830Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7831alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
89d57763 7832doesn't exist.
af4bb4c8
KH
7833
7834Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8a33023e 7835all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
af4bb4c8
KH
7836registry.
7837
8a33023e 7838Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
af4bb4c8
KH
7839slightly different.
7840
7841Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
7842
a933dad1 7843
a933dad1
DL
7844**** Scalable fonts
7845
7846Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
7847since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
7848servers.
7849
7850To enable scalable font use, set the variable
b246b1f6 7851`scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
a933dad1
DL
7852scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
7853Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
7854scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
7855that list. Example:
7856
7857 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
7858
7859allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
7860
a933dad1
DL
7861*** Functions and variables related to font selection.
7862
7863- Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
7864
7865Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
7866is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
7867string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
7868
7869If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
7870the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
7871FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
7872POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
7873SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
7874These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
7875if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
7876REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
7877the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
7878of the face font sort order.
7879
79214ddf 7880- Function: x-font-family-list
a933dad1
DL
7881
7882Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
7883omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
7884(FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
7885non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
7886
7887- Variable: font-list-limit
7888
7889Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
7890won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
7891matching font. The default is currently 100.
7892
a933dad1
DL
7893*** Setting face attributes.
7894
7895For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
7896with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
7897implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
7898`face-attribute'.
7899
7900Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
7901symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
7902
7903The following attributes are recognized:
7904
7905`:family'
7906
7907VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
7908or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
7909and `?' are allowed.
7910
7911`:width'
7912
7913VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
7914It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
7915`condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
7916`extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
7917
7918`:height'
7919
787345ff
MB
7920VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
7921in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
7922scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
7923height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
a933dad1
DL
7924
7925`:weight'
7926
7927VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
7928symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
7929`semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
7930
7931`:slant'
7932
7933VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
7934symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
7935`reverse-oblique'.
7936
7937`:foreground', `:background'
7938
7939VALUE must be a color name, a string.
7940
7941`:underline'
7942
7943VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
7944VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
7945a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
7946don't underline.
7947
7948`:overline'
7949
7950VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
7951VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
7952string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
7953overline.
7954
7955`:strike-through'
7956
7957VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
7958striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
7959face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
7960is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
7961
7962`:box'
7963
7964VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
7965around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
7966VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
7967of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
7968and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
7969VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
7970:color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
7971the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
7972specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
7973defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
7974the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
7975color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
7976should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
7977like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
7978that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
7979the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
7980box.
7981
7982`:inverse-video'
7983
7984VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
7985inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
7986
7987`:stipple'
7988
7989If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
7990The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
7991searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
7992HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
7993is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
7994explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
7995
7996For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7997and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7998
7999`:font'
8000
8001Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8002XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8003is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8004versions of Emacs.
8005
8006For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8007be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8008must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8009
8010Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8011`defface'.
8012
787345ff
MB
8013`:inherit'
8014
8015VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8016of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8017like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8018
a933dad1
DL
8019*** Face attributes and X resources
8020
8021The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8022from X resources:
8023
8024 Face attribute X resource class
8025-----------------------------------------------------------------------
8026 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8027 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8028 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8029 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8030 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8031 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8032 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8033 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8034 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8035 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8036 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8037 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8038 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
79214ddf 8039 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
a933dad1
DL
8040 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8041 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8042 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8043 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8044 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8045
a933dad1
DL
8046*** Text property `face'.
8047
8048The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8049specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8050specification can be
8051
80521. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8053
80542. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8055 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8056 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8057 for face attribute names.
8058
80593. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8060 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8061 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8062
a933dad1
DL
8063** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8064
acf3ecb7
EZ
8065The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8066on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8067the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
a933dad1 8068default. You can get defined colors with a call to
acf3ecb7 8069`defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
a933dad1
DL
8070used to clear the mapping table.
8071
acf3ecb7
EZ
8072** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8073
8074The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8075and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8076type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8077color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8078display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8079old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8080`x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8081compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8082should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8083modify their color-related behavior.
8084
8085The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8086any frame type.
8087
8a5719f0
EZ
8088** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8089
8090The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8091`display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8092`display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8093`display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8094`display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8095`display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8096display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8097the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8098platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8099
27009a49
EZ
8100The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8101display can display image files.
8102
a933dad1 8103** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
a933dad1 8104
463cac2d 8105This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
3b51cca0
MB
8106To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8107the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8108`Inviolable' option.
a933dad1 8109
d586cf1e 8110The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
a933dad1 8111end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
d586cf1e 8112Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
a933dad1 8113
463cac2d
GM
8114** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8115
8116There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8117buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
59927f88 8118property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
463cac2d 8119
9a9dfda8 8120Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
463cac2d 8121forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9a9dfda8 8122to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
463cac2d 8123not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
fc7ac24f
GM
8124commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8125boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8126`inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8127functions.
463cac2d
GM
8128
8129Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9a9dfda8 8130a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
463cac2d 8131editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
a933dad1 8132
9a9dfda8
GM
8133The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8134
59927f88 8135- Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9a9dfda8
GM
8136
8137Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
59927f88 8138
9a9dfda8
GM
8139A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8140If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9b2a085d 8141constrained position if that is different.
9a9dfda8
GM
8142
8143If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8144positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8145ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
59927f88 8146constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9a9dfda8
GM
8147as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8148is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
59927f88
MB
8149fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8150the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8151also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9a9dfda8
GM
8152
8153If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8154NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8155unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8156C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8157only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8158
59927f88
MB
8159If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8160a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8161
8162Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8163
8164- Function: delete-field &optional POS
9a9dfda8 8165
59927f88 8166Delete the field surrounding POS.
9a9dfda8 8167A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8168If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8169
8170- Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8171
8172Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8173A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8174If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8175If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9a9dfda8
GM
8176field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8177
8178- Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8179
8180Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8181A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8182If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8183If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9a9dfda8
GM
8184then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8185
8186- Function: field-string &optional POS
8187
8188Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8189A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8190If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8191
8192- Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8193
8194Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8195A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8196If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8 8197
a933dad1
DL
8198** Image support.
8199
8200Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8201strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8202(AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8203replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8204
8205If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8206`(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8207AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8208window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8209area.
8210
8211IMAGE is an image specification.
8212
8213*** Image specifications
8214
8215Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8216is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8217specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
35a5514b
GM
8218symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8219described below are ignored.
a933dad1
DL
8220
8221The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8222
8223`:ascent ASCENT'
8224
576da55d
GM
8225ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8226If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
5d94f558 8227to use for its ascent.
576da55d
GM
8228
8229If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8230image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8231
5d94f558 8232If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
04545643
GM
8233centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8234of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8235overlays that apply to the image.
a933dad1
DL
8236
8237`:margin MARGIN'
8238
b30623be
GM
8239MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8240as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8241horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
a933dad1
DL
8242
8243`:relief RELIEF'
8244
8245RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8246around an image.
8247
f864120f 8248`:conversion ALGO'
a933dad1 8249
47e351a3
GM
8250Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8251
8252ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8253edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8254
8255ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8256apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8257nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8258position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8259around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8260neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8261transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8262x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8263below.
8264
8265 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8266 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8267 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8268
8269The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8270resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8271multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8272of the factors' absolute values.
8273
327652be 8274Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
a933dad1 8275
47e351a3
GM
8276 (1 0 0
8277 0 0 0
8278 9 9 -1)
8279
8280Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8281
8282 ( 2 -1 0
8283 -1 0 1
8284 0 1 -2)
8285
ba9eeda1
GM
8286ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8287``disabled''.
8288
47e351a3
GM
8289`:mask MASK'
8290
8291If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8292the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8293image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8294background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8a33023e 8295image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
47e351a3
GM
8296the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8297GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8298image.
a933dad1 8299
47e351a3
GM
8300If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8301in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8302`:mask nil'.
a933dad1
DL
8303
8304`:file FILE'
8305
8306Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8307search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8308building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8309may be present in the image specification.
8310
518df5c4
GM
8311`:data DATA'
8312
8313Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8314supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8315present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8316support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8317
a933dad1
DL
8318*** Supported image types
8319
b246b1f6 8320**** XBM, image type `xbm'.
a933dad1
DL
8321
8322XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
0e467b97 8323properties supported are:
a933dad1
DL
8324
8325`:foreground FG'
8326
94736c7c 8327FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8328meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
a933dad1 8329
46c5af7f 8330`:background BG'
a933dad1 8331
0e467b97 8332BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8333meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8334
8335XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8336case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8337instead of a `:file' property.
8338
8339`:width WIDTH'
8340
8341WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8342
8343`:height HEIGHT'
8344
8345HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8346
8347`:data DATA'
8348
8349DATA must be either
8350
8351 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8352 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8353
8354 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8355
8356 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8357 bitmap.
8358
c76e04a8
GM
8359 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8360 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8361 in the file.
8362
a933dad1
DL
8363**** XPM, image type `xpm'
8364
8365XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8366`xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8367found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8368`--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8369
8370Additional image properties supported are:
8371
8372`:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8373
8374SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8375name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8376name.
8377
8378XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8379add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8380
a933dad1
DL
8381The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8382to display compressed images.
8383
8384**** PBM, image type `pbm'
8385
8386PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
2b8e9c91 8387mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
0e467b97 8388mono images are:
2b8e9c91
GM
8389
8390`:foreground FG'
8391
94736c7c 8392FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8393meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
2b8e9c91
GM
8394
8395`:background FG'
8396
0e467b97 8397BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8398meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8399
8400**** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8401
8402Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
0e467b97
JB
8403package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8404properties defined.
3bd37feb 8405
a933dad1
DL
8406**** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8407
8408Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8409package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8410properties defined.
8411
8412**** GIF, image type `gif'
8413
8414Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8415`libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8416
8417Additional image properties supported are:
8418
8419`:index INDEX'
8420
8421INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
ca205aa3
RS
8422multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8423as a hollow box.
a933dad1
DL
8424
8425This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8426For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8427at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8428every 0.1 seconds.
8429
8430(defun show-anim (file max)
8431 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8432 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8433
8434(defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8435 (when (= idx max)
8436 (setq idx 0))
518df5c4 8437 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
a933dad1
DL
8438 (save-excursion
8439 (set-buffer buffer)
8440 (goto-char (point-min))
8441 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8442 (insert-image img "x"))
8443 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8444
8445**** PNG, image type `png'
8446
8447Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8448package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8449properties defined.
8450
8451**** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8452
8453Additional image properties supported are:
8454
8455`:pt-width WIDTH'
8456
8457WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
b246b1f6 8458integer. This is a required property.
a933dad1
DL
8459
8460`:pt-height HEIGHT'
8461
8462HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
b246b1f6 8463must be a integer. This is an required property.
a933dad1
DL
8464
8465`:bounding-box BOX'
8466
8467BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8468the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8469files. This is an required property.
8470
8471Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8472lisp/gs.el.
8473
8474*** Lisp interface.
8475
79214ddf
FP
8476The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8477which are supported in the current configuration.
a933dad1
DL
8478
8479Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8480they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8481The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
084cec2f
GM
8482manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8483images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
a933dad1
DL
8484
8485*** Simplified image API, image.el
8486
8487The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8488creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8489can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8490define an image based on available image types. The functions
8491`put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8492buffer.
8493
a933dad1
DL
8494** Display margins.
8495
8496Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8497and images.
8498
8499To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8500`left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8501`set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8502obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8503`right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8504the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8505of the display margins.
8506
8507You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8508containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8509one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8510string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8511in this file).
8512
a933dad1
DL
8513** Help display
8514
8515Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8516moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8517`help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8518that have a `help-echo' property.
8519
9662da0b 8520If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
85a8aca9 8521is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
c20aeb83
GM
8522the window in which the help was found.
8523
8524If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8525`help-echo' text property was found.
8526
8527If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8528POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8529
8530If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
5ed8d5af 8531the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
c20aeb83 8532mouse.
d5aa31d8 8533
9662da0b
GM
8534If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8535string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8536
8537For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8538determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8539property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8540For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8541used as help string.
a933dad1
DL
8542
8543The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
f0298744
DL
8544the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8545causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
a933dad1 8546
a933dad1
DL
8547** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8548
8549The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8550This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8551
8552The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8553scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8554The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8555scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8556used.
8557
79214ddf
FP
8558 (global-set-key [A-down]
8559 #'(lambda ()
a933dad1 8560 (interactive)
79214ddf 8561 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1 8562 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
79214ddf 8563 (global-set-key [A-up]
a933dad1
DL
8564 #'(lambda ()
8565 (interactive)
79214ddf 8566 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1
DL
8567 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8568
a933dad1
DL
8569** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8570
8571Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8572when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8573variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8574is called with one argument, POS.
8575
8576At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8577characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8578as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8579property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8580`fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8581
a933dad1
DL
8582** Tool bar support.
8583
8584Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8585parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8586controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8587suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8588`auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8589automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8590
8591*** Tool bar item definitions
8592
8593Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8594`tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8595where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
79214ddf 8596
a933dad1
DL
8597CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8598evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8599the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8600property (see below).
79214ddf 8601
a933dad1
DL
8602BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8603binding are currently ignored.
8604
8605The following properties are recognized:
8606
8607`:enable FORM'.
79214ddf 8608
a933dad1
DL
8609FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8610or disabled.
79214ddf 8611
a933dad1 8612`:visible FORM'
79214ddf 8613
a933dad1 8614FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
79214ddf 8615
a933dad1
DL
8616`:filter FUNCTION'
8617
8618FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8619FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8620used instead of BINDING to display this item.
79214ddf 8621
a933dad1
DL
8622`:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8623
8624TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
8625and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
79214ddf 8626
a933dad1
DL
8627`:image IMAGES'
8628
8629IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
8630image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
8631meaning of each of the four elements:
8632
8633 Index Use when item is
8634 ----------------------------------------
8635 0 enabled and selected
8636 1 enabled and deselected
8637 2 disabled and selected
8638 3 disabled and deselected
79214ddf 8639
4ba7246d
GM
8640If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
8641algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
8642
a933dad1 8643`:help HELP-STRING'.
79214ddf 8644
a933dad1
DL
8645Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
8646is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
8647
dab96841 8648The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
d1e68bce
DL
8649toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
8650to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
8651menu bar.
dab96841 8652
8628686a
DL
8653The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
8654dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
8655buffer-locally to override the global map.
8656
a933dad1
DL
8657*** Tool-bar-related variables.
8658
8659If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
8660resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
8661than 1/4 of the frame's size.
8662
79214ddf 8663If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
a933dad1
DL
8664raised when the mouse moves over them.
8665
8666You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
8667`tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
b30623be
GM
8668pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
8669vertical margins . Default is 1.
a933dad1
DL
8670
8671You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
8672`tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
8673
8674*** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
8675
8676You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
79214ddf 8677a tool bar item. If
a933dad1
DL
8678
8679 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
8680 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
8681 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
8682
8683is the original tool bar item definition, then
8684
8685 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
8686
8687makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
8688item.
8689
8690** Mode line changes.
8691
a933dad1
DL
8692*** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
8693
8694The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
8695that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
8696a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
8697
86981. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
8699a `local-map' text property.
8700
87012. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8702that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8703
87043. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8705is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8706`local-map' property.
8707
8708The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8709properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8710example.
8711
54522c9f
GM
8712*** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8713evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8714
a933dad1
DL
8715*** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8716variable mode-line-format to nil.
8717
a933dad1
DL
8718*** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8719
8720This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8721`header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8722completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8723`default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8724line.
8725
8726The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8727`header-line'.
8728
8729The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8730position in the header-line.
8731
a933dad1
DL
8732** Text property `display'
8733
623a0aae
GM
8734The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8735replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8736also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8737the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
a933dad1
DL
8738below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8739
623a0aae
GM
8740*** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8741
8742To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8743text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8744
8745If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8746marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8747the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8748is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8749simpler form STRING as property value.
8750
a933dad1
DL
8751*** Variable width and height spaces
8752
8753To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8754specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8755`(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8756area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8757marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8758displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8759simpler form STRETCH as property value.
8760
8761The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
8762PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
8763properties described below.
8764
8765The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
8766characters having the `display' property.
8767
8768- :width WIDTH
8769
8770Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
8771character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
8772
8773- :relative-width FACTOR
8774
8775Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
8776first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
8777same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
8778width of that character by FACTOR.
8779
8780- :align-to HPOS
8781
8782Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
8783value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
8784
8785Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
8786
8787- :height HEIGHT
8788
8789Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
8790normal line height.
8791
8792- :relative-height FACTOR
8793
8794The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
8795of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
8796
8797- :ascent ASCENT
8798
8799Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
8800used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
8801baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
8802equal to 100.
8803
8804You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
8805
8806*** Images
8807
8808A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
8809. IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
8810in the display, the characters having this display specification in
8811their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
8812the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
8813`(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
8814area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
8815the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
8816as display specification.
8817
8818*** Other display properties
8819
c9e73000 8820- (space-width FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
8821
8822Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
8823should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
8824integer or float.
8825
c9e73000 8826- (height HEIGHT)
a933dad1
DL
8827
8828Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
8829
8830If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
8831means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
8832the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
8833``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
8834a font is available counts as a step.
8835
8836If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
8837as tall as the frame's default font.
8838
8839If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
8840height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
8841
8842Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
8843`height' bound to the current specified font height.
8844
c9e73000 8845- (raise FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
8846
8847FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
8848font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
8849raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
8850amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
c9e73000 8851`height' subproperty.
a933dad1
DL
8852
8853*** Conditional display properties
8854
8855All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
6c6caea2
GM
8856has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
8857only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
8858evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
8859conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
8860bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
8861the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
8862different when object is a string.
a933dad1
DL
8863
8864The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
6c6caea2 8865`(when t . SPEC)'.
a933dad1 8866
a933dad1
DL
8867** New menu separator types.
8868
8869Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
8870item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
8871treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
8872to specify other menu separator types.
8873
8874- `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
8875
8876No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
8877separator occurs.
8878
8879- `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
8880
8881A single line in the menu's foreground color.
8882
8883- `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
8884
8885A double line in the menu's foreground color.
8886
8887- `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
8888
8889A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8890
8891- `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
8892
8893A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8894
8895- `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
8896
f3780fe4 8897A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
a933dad1
DL
8898displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
8899
8900- `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
8901
8902A single line with 3D raised appearance.
8903
8904- `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
8905
8906A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
8907
8908- `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
8909
8910A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
8911
8912- `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
8913
8914Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8915
8916- `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
8917
8918Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
8919
8920- `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
8921
8922Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8923
8924- `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
8925
8926Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
8927
8928Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
8929the corresponding single-line separators.
8930
a933dad1
DL
8931** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
8932
8933The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
8934`scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
8935Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
8936that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
8937default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
8938default background is the background color of the frame, and the
8939default foreground is black.
8940
8941The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
8942(class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
8943`ScrollBarBackground').
8944
8945Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
8946settings for scroll bar colors.
8947
a933dad1
DL
8948** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
8949display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
8950
a933dad1
DL
8951** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
8952starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
8953on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
8954line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
8955the original window start.
8956
a933dad1
DL
8957** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
8958`hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
8959now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
8960
a933dad1
DL
8961** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
8962
8963A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
8964`window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
8965windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
8966other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
8967
8968The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
8969fixed-width and fixed-height.
8970
8971 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
8972
8973A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
8974fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
8975window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
8976change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
8977temporarily to nil, for example
8978
8979 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
8980 (enlarge-window 10))
8981
79214ddf 8982Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
a933dad1 8983or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
e411ce4b
EZ
8984
8985** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
8986terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
8987to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
8988overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
8989horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
8990support a vertical-bar cursor).
76299050 8991
3787e12e 8992
05197f40 8993\f
3787e12e
GM
8994* Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
8995
8996** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8997input.
8998
8999** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9000
9001** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9002
9003** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9004only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9005exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9006(e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9007(e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9008
9009** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9010been added.
9011
05197f40 9012\f
3787e12e
GM
9013* Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9014
9015** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9016
0cb146bf 9017
05197f40 9018\f
3787e12e
GM
9019* Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9020
9021** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9022M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
05197f40 9023\f
3787e12e
GM
9024* Changes in Emacs 20.4
9025
9026** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9027
9028You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9029Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9030`.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9031
9032If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9033is the one that is used.
9034
9035** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9036the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9037Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9038separate from the command's regular output.
9039Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9040says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9041In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9042the buffer name.
9043
9044When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9045output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9046it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9047cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9048
9049** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9050the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9051is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9052created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9053
9054** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9055example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9056match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9057quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9058
9059** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9060now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9061if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9062they never ignore case.
9063
9064** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9065under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9066applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9067of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9068just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9069convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9070part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9071
9072If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9073the same format that was used in the file before.
9074
9075You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9076`inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9077
9078** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9079renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9080This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9081
9082** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9083The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9084buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9085your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9086is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9087end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9088Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9089
9090The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9091eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9092control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9093format. You can now customize these variables.
9094
9095** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9096filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9097filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9098enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9099
9100** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9101in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9102windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9103
9104** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9105dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9106doesn't have any effect.
9107
9108** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9109not one per buffer.
9110
9111** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9112use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9113 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9114
9115** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9116To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9117`auto-show-mode' command.
9118
9119** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9120avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9121versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9122choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9123occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9124
9125** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9126cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9127
9128** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9129character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9130feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9131
9132** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9133the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9134interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9135and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9136
9137** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9138
9139The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9140that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9141one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9142codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9143set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9144
9145Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9146from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9147
9148IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9149equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9150a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9151`?' on other systems.
9152
9153IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9154feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9155Unix.
9156
9157Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9158current codepage when it starts.
9159
9160** Mail changes
9161
9162*** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9163`mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9164appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9165non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9166MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9167headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9168latin-1:
9169
9170 MIME-version: 1.0
9171 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9172 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9173
9174*** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9175default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9176default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9177sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9178buffer-file-coding-system.
9179
9180You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9181sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9182mail.
9183
9184*** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9185if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9186Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9187list of possible coding systems.
9188
9189** CC Mode changes
9190
9191*** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9192modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9193longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9194docstring for details.
9195
9196*** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9197symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9198found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9199prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9200lineup functions use this feature currently.
9201
9202*** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9203"finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9204
9205*** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9206"catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9207
9208*** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9209from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9210symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9211c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9212anonymous classes.
9213
9214*** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9215syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9216
9217*** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9218inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9219support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9220function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9221
9222*** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9223(i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9224brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9225c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9226(brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9227
9228*** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9229
9230*** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9231
9232*** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9233for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9234
9235*** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9236
9237*** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9238associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9239This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9240circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9241class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9242
9243** Gnus changes.
9244
9245*** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9246added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9247Gnus manual for the full story.
9248
9249*** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9250before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9251group, which is created automatically.
9252
9253*** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9254values.
9255
9256*** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9257
9258*** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9259outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9260
9261*** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9262`C-u C-c C-c'.
9263
9264*** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9265
9266*** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9267re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9268
9269*** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9270
9271*** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9272Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9273
9274*** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9275`a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9276
9277*** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9278control over simplification.
9279
9280*** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9281
9282*** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9283limit.
9284
9285*** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9286
9287*** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9288
9289*** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9290If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9291rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9292
8a33023e 9293*** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
3787e12e
GM
9294`a' forces normal posting method.
9295
9296*** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9297-- `W d'.
9298
9299*** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9300to a non-nil value.
9301
9302*** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9303where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9304
9305*** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9306has been added.
9307
9308*** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9309
9310*** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9311
9312*** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9313`gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9314
9315*** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9316`message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9317
9318*** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9319
9320*** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9321been added.
9322
9323*** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9324`gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9325
9326*** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9327updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9328
9329*** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9330
9331*** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9332
9333*** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9334
9335** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9336
9337*** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9338options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9339nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9340
9341*** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9342TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9343of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9344TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9345can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9346
9347*** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9348All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9349but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9350the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9351
9352*** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9353the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9354buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9355mismatch.
9356
9357** Changes to RefTeX mode
9358
9359*** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9360file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9361
9362*** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9363lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9364characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9365removed from the label.
9366
9367*** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9368a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9369
9370*** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9371customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9372
9373*** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9374`reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9375expressions.
9376
9377*** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9378
9379** New/deleted modes and packages
9380
9381*** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9382SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9383
9384*** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9385editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9386SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9387
9388*** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9389changes with a special face.
9390
9391*** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9392this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9393Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
05197f40 9394\f
3787e12e
GM
9395* MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9396
9397** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9398This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9399conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9400and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9401check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9402
9403The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9404Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9405distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9406
9407** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9408MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9409controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9410directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9411Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9412on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9413string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9414program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9415printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9416
9417** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9418output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9419available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9420input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9421temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9422program.
9423
9424An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9425and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9426programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9427automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9428as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9429ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9430
9431** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9432a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9433MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9434was not documented clearly before.
9435
9436** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9437This includes Tetris and Snake.
05197f40 9438\f
3787e12e
GM
9439* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9440
9441** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9442return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9443They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9444meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9445
9446** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9447WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9448and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9449
9450** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9451
9452*** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9453It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9454
9455*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9456the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9457integers.
9458
9459** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9460files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9461arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9462file names and attributes are returned.
9463
9464** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9465sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8a33023e 9466accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
3787e12e
GM
9467It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9468returns the result.
9469
9470** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9471to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9472
9473** New functions for base64 conversion:
9474
9475The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9476into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9477performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9478optionally.
9479
9480Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9481job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9482
9483**
9484The new function process-running-child-p
9485will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9486terminal to its own child process.
9487
9488** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9489when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9490to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9491itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9492
9493** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9494be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9495
4a389f53 9496** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
3787e12e
GM
9497:included is an alias for :visible.
9498
9499easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9500easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9501to move or copy menu entries.
9502
9503** Multibyte editing changes
9504
9505*** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9506an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9507make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9508work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9509char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9510 (setq char (sref str idx)
9511 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9512The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9513
9514If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9515(say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9516 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9517
9518*** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9519region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9520deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9521
8a33023e 9522 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
3787e12e
GM
9523
9524This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9525across the boundary.
9526
9527*** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9528`unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9529 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9530 contains 8-bit characters.
9531 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9532 contains invalid characters.
9533
9534*** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9535text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9536preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9537text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9538way.
9539
9540*** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9541If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9542end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9543prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9544
9545*** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9546compose Thai characters in a string.
9547
9548** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9549argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9550for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9551menus should always use the third argument.
9552
9553** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9554read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9555arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9556input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9557
9558** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9559of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9560programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9561inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9562
9563** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9564the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9565returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9566echo area contents.
9567
9568 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9569
9570** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9571NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9572requested feature cannot be loaded.
9573
9574** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9575foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9576means to clear out that attribute.
9577
9578** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9579gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9580
9581** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9582read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9583unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9584end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9585
9586** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9587the gap of the current buffer.
9588
9589** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9590to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9591current buffer.
9592
9593** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9594facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9595These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9596it back in after any modifications have been made.
05197f40 9597\f
3787e12e
GM
9598* Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9599
9600** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9601the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9602/usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9603directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9604subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9605
9606Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9607names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9608Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9609which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9610these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9611
9612Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9613starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9614time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9615
9616This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9617Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9618to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9619subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9620`.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9621results.
9622
9623** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9624GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
9625that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
9626fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
05197f40 9627\f
3787e12e
GM
9628* Changes in Emacs 20.3
9629
9630** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
9631including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
9632it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
9633perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
9634
9635** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
9636specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
9637region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
9638further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
9639command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
9640within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
9641are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
9642region.
9643
9644In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
9645selective undo.
9646
9647** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
9648unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
9649buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
9650effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
9651Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
9652
9653The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
9654though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
9655-*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
9656load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
9657
9658** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
9659no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
9660enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
9661something that most users not do.
9662
9663** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
9664operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
9665The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
9666applications.
9667
9668C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
9669pasting operations.
9670
9671** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
9672setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
9673like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
9674printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
9675`ps-printer-name'.
9676
9677** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
9678minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
9679any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
9680except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
9681incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
9682hits a new word.
9683
9684Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
9685Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
9686to be confused by TeX commands.
9687
9688You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
9689correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
9690clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
9691of various alternative replacements and actions.
9692
9693Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
9694the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
9695corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
9696alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
9697flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
9698
9699Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9700flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9701
9702** Changes in input method usage.
9703
9704Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9705the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9706respectively.
9707
9708You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9709
9710If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9711of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9712
9713The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9714that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9715
9716 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9717
9718 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9719
9720 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9721 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9722
9723 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9724 given in the following case:
9725 o When you are using a complex input method.
9726 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9727
9728If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9729input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9730and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9731setting it to t is helpful.
9732
9733The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9734
9735In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9736keys:
9737 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9738 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9739 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9740These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9741environment.
9742
9743** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9744names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9745minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9746get
9747
9748 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9749
9750which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9751
9752Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9753Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9754
9755** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9756at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9757its owner and group.
9758
9759** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
9760Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
9761
9762** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
9763contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
9764
9765** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
9766which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
9767in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
9768by the left edge of the rectangle.
9769
9770** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
9771increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
9772C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
9773for writing keyboard macros.
9774
9775** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
9776files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
9777frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
9778the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
9779additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
9780info.
9781
9782** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
9783
9784** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
9785query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
9786contents only.
9787
9788** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
9789confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
9790the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
9791says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
9792
9793** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
9794non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
9795literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
9796
9797** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
9798now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
9799Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
9800inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
9801
9802** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
9803failure if the command produces no output.
9804
9805** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
9806manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
9807the mouse.
9808
9809** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
9810mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
9811function and variable names.
9812
9813** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
9814reading specific files. This has higher priority than
9815file-coding-system-alist.
9816
9817** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
9818t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
9819converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
9820the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
9821according to the current fontset.
9822
9823** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
9824
9825The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
9826that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
9827nonascii-insert-offset.
9828
9829For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
9830enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
9831nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
9832characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
9833
9834** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
9835an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
9836
9837** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
9838letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
9839
9840** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
9841are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
9842command keys.
9843
9844** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
9845user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
9846
9847Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
9848user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
9849all variables that have documentation.
9850
9851** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
9852shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
9853that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
9854minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
9855it should show; the default is 20.
9856
9857Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
9858the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
9859of your input.
9860
9861** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
9862all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
9863recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
9864argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
9865the customizable options which were changed since that version.
9866Newly added options are included as well.
9867
9868If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
9869then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
9870for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
9871
9872This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
9873Customize menu.
9874
9875** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
9876the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
9877
9878** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
9879buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
9880invoked.
9881
9882** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
9883that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
9884The default is 1.
9885
9886** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
9887syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
9888new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
9889(C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
9890sensibly.
9891
9892** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
9893
9894** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
9895value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
9896two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
9897
9898** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
9899reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
9900for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
9901every night.
9902
9903** Desktop changes
9904
9905*** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
9906the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
9907
9908*** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
9909and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
9910
9911** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
9912read and post multi-lingual articles.
9913
9914** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
9915doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
9916be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
9917outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
9918the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
9919made invisible again.
9920
9921** Mail reading and sending changes
9922
9923*** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
9924the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
9925changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
9926toggle.
9927
9928*** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
9929now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
9930summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
9931the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
9932rmail-default-body-file.
9933
9934*** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
9935longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
9936handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
9937
9938*** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
9939it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
9940is evaluated to insert the signature.
9941
9942*** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
9943outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
9944handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
9945putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
9946transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
9947especially interested in trying feedmail.
9948
9949feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
9950feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
9951provided by feedmail are:
9952
9953**** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
9954stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
9955there is also a queue for draft messages
9956
9957**** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
9958be prompted for confirmation
9959
9960**** does smart filling of address headers
9961
9962**** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
9963the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
9964can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
9965
9966**** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
9967the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
9968/usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
9969function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
9970
9971** Dired changes
9972
9973*** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
9974files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
9975
9976*** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
9977run Dired on the directory name at point.
9978
9979*** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
9980files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
9981for a specified regexp.
9982
9983** VC Changes
9984
9985*** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
9986conveniently.
9987
9988*** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
9989faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
9990Dired.
9991
9992VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
9993directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
9994listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
9995currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9996
9997You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9998then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9999vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10000control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10001on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10002
10003All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10004is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10005`v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10006the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10007`vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10008
10009The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10010toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10011VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10012`* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10013
10014Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10015ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10016command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10017
10018*** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10019file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10020session to resolve them.
10021
10022Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10023resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10024contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10025uses as well).
10026
10027*** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10028command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10029you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10030either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10031branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10032If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10033using ediff.
10034
10035** Changes in Font Lock
10036
10037*** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10038are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10039use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10040unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10041compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10042
10043** Frame name display changes
10044
10045*** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10046frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10047raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10048when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10049
10050*** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10051frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10052menu.
10053
10054** Comint (subshell) changes
10055
10056*** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10057subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10058with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10059
10060*** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10061
10062C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10063that is, the line after the last line you got.
10064You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10065
10066C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10067send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10068the following line.
10069
10070C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10071which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10072previously sent input.
10073
10074C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10075it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10076as the search string.
10077
10078*** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10079automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10080
10081** C mode changes
10082
10083*** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10084and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10085assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10086definition.
10087
10088*** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10089(i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10090Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10091style is still the default however.
10092
10093*** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10094
10095*** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10096are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10097them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10098
10099*** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10100and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10101
10102*** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10103namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10104
10105*** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10106makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10107
10108*** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10109c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10110
10111*** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10112should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10113package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10114variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10115
10116** Changes to hippie-expand.
10117
10118*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10119non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10120which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10121
10122*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10123non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10124expanding dynamically.
10125
10126*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10127non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10128
10129*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10130non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10131this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10132expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10133
10134*** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10135
10136** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10137
10138*** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10139bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10140automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10141bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10142against the first word in the title.
10143
10144*** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10145capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10146bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10147lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10148lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10149bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10150
10151*** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10152generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10153replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10154bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10155
10156** Changes in vcursor.el.
10157
10158*** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10159and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10160variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10161entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10162`vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10163in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10164
10165*** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10166Editing group once the package is loaded.
10167
10168*** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10169generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
8a33023e 10170vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
3787e12e
GM
10171
10172*** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10173vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10174
10175** Ispell changes.
10176
10177*** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10178buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10179are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10180
10181*** Generic region skipping implemented.
10182A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10183and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10184defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10185include:
10186
10187 o URLs are automatically skipped
10188 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10189
10190*** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10191
10192** Changes to RefTeX mode
10193
10194RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10195large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10196re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10197section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10198
10199*** New recursive parser.
10200
10201The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10202entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10203recursive parser scans the individual files.
10204
10205*** Parsing only part of a document.
10206
10207Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10208partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10209the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10210
10211 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10212
10213*** Storing parsing information in a file.
10214
10215This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10216
10217 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10218
10219*** Using multiple selection buffers
10220
10221If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10222for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10223
10224 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10225
10226*** References to external documents.
10227
10228The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10229documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10230documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10231macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10232RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10233the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10234The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10235
10236*** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10237
8a33023e 10238The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
3787e12e
GM
10239and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10240
10241Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10242the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10243
10244*** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10245
10246The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10247buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10248
10249*** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10250
10251The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10252contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10253`reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10254have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10255enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10256at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10257more.
10258
10259*** Support for the varioref package
10260
10261The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10262
10263*** New hooks
10264
10265Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10266and citations are created. These hooks are
10267`reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10268`reftex-format-cite-function'.
10269
10270*** Citations outside LaTeX
10271
10272The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10273a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10274
10275*** Short context is no longer fontified.
10276
10277The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10278fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10279fontified, use
10280
10281 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10282
10283** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10284With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10285the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10286directories that contain the same file name.
10287
10288Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10289Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10290file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10291Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10292have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10293names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10294directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10295directory.
10296
10297** New modes and packages
10298
10299*** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10300It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10301it, but some do not.
10302
10303*** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10304code.
10305
10306*** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10307current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10308around in a buffer.
10309
10310Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10311
10312*** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10313uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10314be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10315established system of notation similar to Chess.
10316
10317*** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10318documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10319guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10320
10321*** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10322available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10323system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10324simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10325functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10326the like.
10327
10328*** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10329identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10330
10331*** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10332within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10333used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10334the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10335
10336*** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10337
10338 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10339 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10340 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10341 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10342 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10343 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10344 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10345 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10346 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10347 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10348 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10349
10350 Platform-specific modes:
10351
10352 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10353 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10354 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10355 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10356 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10357 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10358 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10359 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10360 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
05197f40 10361\f
3787e12e
GM
10362* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10363
10364** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10365use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10366That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10367Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10368
10369Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10370you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10371consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10372
10373** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10374and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10375specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10376searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10377
10378** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10379multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10380character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10381environment.
10382
10383** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10384take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10385string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10386current input method for reading this one event.
10387
10388** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10389now control whether to output certain characters as
10390backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10391non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10392characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10393in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
05197f40 10394\f
3787e12e
GM
10395* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10396
10397** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10398of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10399
10400** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10401in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10402always increases point by 1.
10403
10404The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10405considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10406
10407See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10408
10409** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10410Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10411default value changed. For example,
10412
10413 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10414 :type 'integer
10415 :group 'foo
10416 :version "20.3")
10417
10418 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10419 :version "20.3")
10420
10421If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10422default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10423is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10424`:version' in the top level group.
10425
10426This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10427
10428** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10429starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10430
10431However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10432symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10433support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10434to themselves.
10435
10436If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10437this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10438values whatever.
10439
10440** There is a new debugger command, R.
10441It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10442in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10443
10444** Frame-local variables.
10445
10446You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10447the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10448local bindings for that variable.
10449
10450These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10451frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10452modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10453parameter name.
10454
10455Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10456Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10457active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10458that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10459
10460It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10461clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10462very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10463through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10464
10465** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10466"symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10467evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10468makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10469See the documentation in sregex.el.
10470
10471** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10472is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10473parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10474The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10475
10476** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10477If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10478
10479** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10480known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10481define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10482
10483** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10484when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10485it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10486history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10487
10488The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10489return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10490empty input.
10491
10492** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10493for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10494`iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10495Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10496`read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10497
10498** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10499echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10500a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10501default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10502
10503** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10504specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10505function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10506place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10507non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10508
10509** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10510If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10511up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10512end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10513
10514** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10515which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10516If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10517
10518** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10519holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10520was directed to display this buffer.
10521
10522** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10523with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10524describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10525other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10526set-window-configuration.
10527
10528** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10529window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10530positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10531windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10532
10533** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10534override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10535look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10536
10537If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10538non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10539map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10540
10541minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10542and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10543
10544** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10545except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10546
10547** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10548USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10549floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10550
10551** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10552to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10553in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10554it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10555
10556** Menu changes
10557
10558*** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10559keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10560better supported.
10561
10562The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10563a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10564you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10565can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10566then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10567
10568*** A new format for menu items is supported.
10569
10570In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10571 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10572defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10573starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10574
10575The format is:
10576 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10577 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10578where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10579string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10580The supported properties include
10581
10582:enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10583 item is enabled.
10584:visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10585 item should appear in the menu.
10586:filter FILTER-FN
10587 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10588 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10589 It should return a binding to use instead.
10590:keys DESCRIPTION
10591 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
f3780fe4 10592 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
3787e12e
GM
10593 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10594:key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10595 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10596 keyboard binding.
10597:key-sequence nil
10598 This means that the command normally has no
10599 keyboard equivalent.
10600:help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10601:button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10602 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10603 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10604 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10605
10606Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10607Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10608
10609(menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10610
10611** New event types
10612
10613*** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10614mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10615corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10616which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10617
10618 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10619
10620where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10621same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10622indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10623negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10624the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
10625forward, away from the user.
10626
10627As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10628
10629*** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
10630files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
10631and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
10632filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
10633loaded into Emacs. The format is:
10634
10635 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
10636
10637where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10638same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
10639that were dragged and dropped.
10640
10641As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10642
10643** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
10644
10645*** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
10646any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
10647to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
10648
10649*** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
10650can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
10651that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
10652
10653*** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
10654in Emacs 19 and before.
10655
10656The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
10657The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
10658
10659*** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
10660buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
10661unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
10662representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
10663
10664This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
10665as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
10666viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
10667one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
10668will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
10669
10670This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
10671representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
10672(including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
10673consistent with the new representation.
10674
10675*** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
10676representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
10677about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
10678however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10679
10680The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
10681nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
10682using the table nonascii-translation-table.
10683
10684*** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
10685representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
10686representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10687
10688The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
10689loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
10690is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
10691
10692*** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10693which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
10694
10695*** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10696which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
10697
10698*** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
10699portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10700so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10701You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10702
10703*** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10704it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10705
10706*** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10707convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10708buffer or string being searched.
10709
10710One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10711[...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10712searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10713searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10714obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10715you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10716expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10717
10718*** Structure of coding system changed.
10719
10720All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10721by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10722which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10723as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10724vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10725your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10726define-coding-system-alias.
10727
10728The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10729the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10730access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10731pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10732character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10733safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10734'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10735`iso-8859-1'.
10736
10737Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10738The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10739coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10740(coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10741
10742Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10743also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10744are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10745the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10746
10747*** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10748proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10749This function requires a user interaction.
10750
10751*** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10752find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10753select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10754systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10755a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10756select-safe-coding-system.
10757
10758*** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
10759decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
10760last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
10761was done.
10762
10763*** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
10764used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
10765coding systems used by some specific language environment.
10766
10767*** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
10768return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
10769characters are found, they now return a list of single element
10770`undecided' or its subsidiaries.
10771
10772*** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
10773coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
10774coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
10775converted.
10776
10777*** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
10778coding system for communicating with other X clients.
10779
10780*** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
10781character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
10782character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
10783each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
10784either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
10785range of characters.
10786
10787*** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
10788Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
10789
10790*** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
10791in the current buffer at position POS.
10792
10793*** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
10794input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
10795function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
10796character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
10797event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
10798binding input-method-function to nil.
10799
10800The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
10801method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
10802input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
10803the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
10804not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
10805
10806The input method function is not called when reading the second and
10807subsequent events of a key sequence.
10808
10809*** You can customize any language environment by using
10810set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
10811
10812The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
10813customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
10814instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
10815environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
10816exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
05197f40 10817\f
3787e12e
GM
10818* Changes in Emacs 20.1
10819
10820** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
10821options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
10822at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
10823tree structure.
10824
10825M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
10826user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
10827
10828With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
10829session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
10830in your .emacs file.)
10831
10832** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
10833You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
10834
10835** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
10836This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
10837
10838** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
10839immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
10840kills the region.
10841
10842The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
10843delete the character before point, as usual.
10844
10845** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
10846on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
10847by setting search-highlight to nil.)
10848
10849** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
10850insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
10851the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
10852onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
10853history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
10854past.)
10855
10856** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
10857This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
10858in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
10859TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
10860makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
10861
10862As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
10863and is an alias for it.
10864
10865If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
10866use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
10867
10868** Scrolling changes
10869
10870*** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
10871position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
10872
10873In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
10874on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
10875where it started.
10876
10877*** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
10878move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
10879screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
10880does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
10881
10882*** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
10883top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
10884comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
10885recenters the window.
10886
10887** International character set support (MULE)
10888
10889Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
10890including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
10891Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
10892Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
10893features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
10894MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
10895
10896Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
10897coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
10898character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
10899variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
10900into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
10901
10902Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
10903generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
10904supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
10905language, to make it possible to type them.
10906
10907The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
10908character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
10909
10910The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
10911to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
10912
10913You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
10914
10915 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
10916
10917Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
10918characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
10919argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
10920already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
10921characters for their work until they want to change.
10922
10923*** Input methods
10924
10925An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
10926specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
10927has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
10928the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
10929support several input methods.
10930
10931The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
10932another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
10933work.
10934
10935A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
10936characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
10937composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
10938consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
10939sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
10940letter.
10941
10942The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
10943by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
10944First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
10945marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
10946mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
10947
10948None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
10949they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
10950phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
10951converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
10952
10953Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
10954word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
10955typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
10956the first guess is wrong.
10957
10958*** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
10959turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
10960
10961If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
10962byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
10963they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
10964the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
10965
10966However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
10967use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
10968includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
10969translate automatically to and from either one.
10970
10971*** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
10972
10973Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
10974file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
10975sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
10976what you want.
10977
10978If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
10979example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
10980system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
10981multibyte characters in that buffer.
10982
10983If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
10984character conversion as well.
10985
10986*** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
10987
10988A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
10989Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
10990requires using many fonts.
10991
10992Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
10993collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
10994
10995A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10996the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10997have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10998you would use a font.
10999
11000If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11001specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11002display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11003
11004The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11005(that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
f327c2f9 11006characters).
3787e12e
GM
11007
11008*** Defining fontsets.
11009
11010Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11011chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11012with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11013
11014Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11015of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11016`fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11017standard fontset are created automatically.
11018
11019If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11020argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11021FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11022with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11023name is `fontset-startup'.
11024
11025Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11026The resource value should have this form:
11027 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11028FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11029 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11030 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11031 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11032The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11033of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
0969bd6a
EZ
11034CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11035should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
3787e12e
GM
11036
11037Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11038last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11039You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11040
11041For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11042font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11043following resource,
11044 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11045the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11046 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11047Here is the substitution rule:
11048 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11049 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11050 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11051 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11052 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11053
11054The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11055fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11056that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11057
11058With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11059like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11060name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11061fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11062fontsets.
11063
11064*** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11065defaults for a particular choice of language.
11066
11067Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11068method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11069visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11070already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11071language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11072system for new files that you create.
11073
11074It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11075set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11076whole Emacs session.
11077
11078For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11079chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11080with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11081
11082*** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11083specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11084specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11085the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11086coding systems that Emacs supports.
11087
11088*** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11089lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11090This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11091After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11092is used for *the immediately following command*.
11093
11094So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11095write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11096
11097If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11098then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11099
c3518b63 11100For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
3787e12e
GM
11101visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11102
11103*** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11104construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11105to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11106specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11107of the file.
11108
11109*** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11110the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11111code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11112translated into that character code.
11113
11114This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11115various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11116
11117By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11118
11119*** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11120the coding system for keyboard input.
11121
11122Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11123with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11124some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11125
11126By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11127
11128Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11129input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11130translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11131to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11132designed to work with terminals.
11133
11134*** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11135specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11136This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11137has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11138translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11139in the corresponding buffer.
11140
11141By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11142
11143*** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11144to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11145It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11146
11147*** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11148an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11149command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11150want to use.
11151
11152C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11153method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11154
11155*** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11156layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11157remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11158which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11159
11160*** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11161the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11162related information.
11163
11164*** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11165HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11166scripts.
11167
11168*** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11169information about the support for a particular language.
11170You specify the language as an argument.
11171
11172*** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11173the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11174first dash.
11175
11176A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11177(except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11178whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
111791 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11180
11181 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11182 B big5 (Chinese)
11183 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11184 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11185 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11186 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11187 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11188 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11189 K euc-korea (Korean)
11190 R koi8 (Russian)
11191 Q tibetan
11192 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11193 T lao
11194 T tis620 (Thai)
11195 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11196 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11197 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11198 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11199 z hz (Chinese)
11200
11201When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11202two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11203coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11204keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11205
11206*** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11207conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11208
11209When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11210into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11211rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11212Rmail files themselves.
11213
11214*** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11215conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11216
11217Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11218for sending mail:
11219
11220- If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11221- Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11222- Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11223 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11224- Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11225
11226*** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11227to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11228Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11229translations.
11230
11231** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11232of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11233insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11234without any conversion.
11235
11236** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11237You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11238RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11239any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11240
11241** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11242functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11243
11244Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11245Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11246
11247Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11248mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11249
11250** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11251complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11252in the buffer before point.
11253
11254With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11255symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11256you are using.
11257
11258With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11259just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11260
11261** File locking works with NFS now.
11262
11263The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11264in the same directory as FILENAME.
11265
11266This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11267works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11268can become a bottleneck.
11269
11270The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11271does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11272create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11273file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11274rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11275so useful that the change is worth while.
11276
11277When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11278are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11279collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11280tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11281
11282** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11283it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11284show-paren-mode.
11285
11286** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11287selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11288delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11289
11290** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11291within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11292complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11293
11294** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11295it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11296set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11297
11298** Changes in View mode.
11299
11300*** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11301Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11302
11303*** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11304view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11305
11306*** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11307previous state.
11308
11309*** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11310scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11311
11312*** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11313non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11314not just the selected window.
11315
11316*** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11317read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11318turns View mode on or off.
11319
11320*** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11321how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11322delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11323
11324** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11325now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11326
11327** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11328has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11329presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11330which version to compare with.
11331
11332** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11333blocks if a match is inside the block.
11334
11335The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11336is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11337isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11338shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11339
11340By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11341of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11342blocks, all of them or none.
11343
11344** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11345current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11346confirmation first.
11347
11348** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11349now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11350However, the mode will not be changed if
11351(1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11352(2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11353 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11354(3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11355
11356This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11357
11358However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11359these commands do not change the major mode.
11360
11361** M-x occur changes.
11362
11363*** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11364it performs a case-sensitive search.
11365
11366*** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11367if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11368using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11369
11370** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11371in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11372window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11373that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11374buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11375
11376** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11377after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11378appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11379come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11380
11381** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11382selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11383buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11384
11385** Outline mode changes.
11386
11387*** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11388
11389*** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11390
11391** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11392you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11393Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11394was already active.
11395
11396The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11397unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11398get confused by it.
11399
11400If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11401set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11402
11403** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11404
11405*** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11406conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11407character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11408including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11409
11410The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11411mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11412copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11413
11414*** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11415are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11416values.
11417
11418`dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11419case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11420`dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11421case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11422
11423** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11424certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11425can be. The default value is 30.
11426
11427** Changes in Mail mode.
11428
11429*** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11430Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11431composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11432`mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11433`sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11434behavior.
11435
11436C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11437compose-mail-other-frame.
11438
11439*** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11440the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11441replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11442buffer that shows the original message.
11443
11444*** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11445with separator lines around the contents.
11446
11447*** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11448in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11449definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11450need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11451
11452*** New features in the mail-complete command.
11453
11454**** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11455for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11456controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11457Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11458
11459**** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11460to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11461/etc/passwd.
11462
11463**** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11464to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11465/etc/passwd.
11466
11467** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11468special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11469directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11470reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11471
11472Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11473when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11474be taken to be magic.
11475
11476** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11477files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11478available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11479
11480M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11481(-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11482
11483** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11484suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11485
11486In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11487
11488new key dired.el binding old key
11489------- ---------------- -------
11490 * c dired-change-marks c
11491 * m dired-mark m
11492 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11493 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11494 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11495 * u dired-unmark u
11496 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
3a426197 11497 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
3787e12e
GM
11498 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11499 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11500 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11501 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11502
11503** Rmail changes.
11504
11505*** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11506saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11507chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11508each time you run it.
11509
11510*** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11511whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11512
11513*** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11514messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11515means to move in the opposite direction.
11516
11517*** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11518you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11519
11520*** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11521just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11522It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11523can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11524for output.
11525
11526** Gnus changes.
11527
11528*** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11529
11530*** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11531Gnus.
11532
11533*** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11534`and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11535
11536*** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11537article mode line.
11538
11539*** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11540
11541*** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11542
11543(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11544
11545*** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11546are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11547`gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11548
11549*** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11550
11551*** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11552
11553*** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11554See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11555
11556*** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11557Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11558used to pick articles.
11559
11560*** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11561another have been added.
11562
11563 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11564
11565*** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11566generating lines in buffers.
11567
11568*** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
3a426197 11569`C-M-_'.
3787e12e
GM
11570
11571*** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11572
11573*** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11574
11575 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11576
11577*** Scores can be decayed.
11578
11579 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11580
11581*** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11582Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11583
11584*** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11585the native server.
11586
11587 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11588
11589*** A new command for reading collections of documents
3a426197 11590(nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
3787e12e
GM
11591
11592*** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11593
11594*** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11595even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11596
11597*** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11598(DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11599
11600 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11601 a group.
11602
11603*** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11604sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11605
11606 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11607
11608*** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11609
11610 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11611
11612*** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11613
11614 Use the `Y c' command.
11615
11616*** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11617
11618*** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11619
11620 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11621
11622*** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11623from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11624
11625 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
11626
11627*** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
11628
11629*** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
11630the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
11631
11632 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
11633
11634Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
11635and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
11636from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
11637hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
11638this issue.)
11639
11640Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
11641automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
11642particular news group. This can be done by:
11643
11644 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
11645
11646Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
11647of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
11648"XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
11649system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
11650for reading and posting).
11651
11652CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
11653 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
11654Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
11655newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
11656there.
11657
11658Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
11659default. Here are some of these default settings:
11660
11661 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
11662 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
11663 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
11664 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
11665 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
11666
11667When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
11668the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
11669
11670** CC mode changes.
11671
11672*** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
11673code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
11674values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
11675this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
11676Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
11677loaded.
11678
11679If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
11680Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
11681style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
11682share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
11683c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
11684must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
11685
11686*** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
11687of the current buffer.
11688
11689*** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
11690it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
11691of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
11692
11693*** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
11694style that the Python developers like.
11695
11696*** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
11697This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
11698just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
11699
11700** VC Changes [new]
11701
9614842d 11702*** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
3787e12e
GM
11703name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11704directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11705
11706This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11707master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11708developers.
11709
11710You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11711RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11712
11713*** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11714other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11715writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11716calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11717
11718*** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11719version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11720
11721** Calendar changes.
11722
9614842d
JW
11723*** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11724subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11725you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11726following/previous years.
11727
11728*** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11729the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11730calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11731each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11732calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11733supposed attribute of God.
3787e12e
GM
11734
11735** ps-print changes
11736
2261f14e
GM
11737There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11738layout.
3787e12e 11739
2261f14e 11740*** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
3787e12e 11741
2261f14e
GM
11742Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11743be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11744printer system has this behavior, set variable
11745`ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
3787e12e 11746
2261f14e
GM
11747If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11748blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
a5d03456 11749very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
3787e12e 11750
2261f14e
GM
11751The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11752setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
3787e12e 11753
2261f14e
GM
11754 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11755 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11756 printing for your printer.
3787e12e 11757
2261f14e
GM
11758 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
11759 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 11760
2261f14e
GM
11761 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
11762 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 11763
2261f14e
GM
11764The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
11765opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
11766`ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
11767bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
11768ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
11769This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
11770The default value is nil.
3787e12e 11771
2261f14e
GM
11772The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
11773properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
3787e12e 11774
2261f14e
GM
11775 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
11776 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
11777 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
11778 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
11779 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
11780 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
11781 color). The default is 0 ("black").
3787e12e 11782
2261f14e
GM
11783 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
11784 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
11785
11786 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
11787 The default is 0 ("black").
11788
11789 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
11790 The default is 0 ("black").
11791
11792 border-width Specify the border width.
11793 The default is 0.4.
11794
11795Any other property is ignored.
11796
11797Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
11798`ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
11799documentation).
11800
11801Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
11802`ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
11803`ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
11804`ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
11805`ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
11806controlling headers.
3787e12e 11807
2261f14e
GM
11808*** Color management (subgroup)
11809
11810If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
11811color.
11812
11813*** Face Management (subgroup)
3787e12e 11814
2261f14e
GM
11815If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
11816set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
11817background should be used. Valid values are:
11818
11819 t always use face background color.
11820 nil never use face background color.
11821 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
11822
11823*** N-up printing (subgroup)
11824
11825The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
11826sheet of paper.
11827
11828The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
11829between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
11830
11831If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
11832each page.
11833
11834The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
11835on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
11836`ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
11837
11838 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
11839 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
11840 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
3787e12e 11841
2261f14e
GM
11842 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
11843 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
11844 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
11845
11846 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
11847 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
11848 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
11849
11850 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
11851 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
11852 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
3787e12e 11853
2261f14e
GM
11854Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
11855
11856*** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
3787e12e 11857
2261f14e
GM
11858The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
11859RGB color.
11860
11861The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
11862continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
11863to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
11864
11865 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
11866 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11867 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11868 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11869 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11870 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
11871 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
11872 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
11873 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11874 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11875 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11876 10 + 10 +
11877 11 + 11 +
11878 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11879 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11880 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
11881 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
11882 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
11883 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11884 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11885 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11886 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
11887 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
11888 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
11889 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
11890 22 + 22 +
11891 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11892
11893Any other value is treated as `nil'.
11894
11895
11896*** Printer management (subgroup)
11897
11898The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
11899some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
11900`ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
11901utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
11902to "-P".
11903
11904The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
11905paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
11906non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
11907
11908The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
11909should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
11910do so.
11911
11912*** Page settings (subgroup)
11913
11914If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
11915error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
11916indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
11917instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
11918the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
11919by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
11920`setpagedevice'.
11921
11922The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
11923printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
11924`upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
11925
11926The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
11927it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
11928integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
11929specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
11930is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
11931its TO, are ignored.
11932
11933The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
11934pages. Valid values are:
11935
11936 nil print all pages.
11937
11938 `even-page' print only even pages.
11939
11940 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
11941
11942 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
11943 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11944 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
11945 print only the even sheet of paper.
11946
11947 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
11948 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11949 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
11950 only the odd sheet of paper.
11951
11952Any other value is treated as nil.
11953
11954If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
11955are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
11956`ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
11957
11958 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
11959
11960and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
11961`ps-n-up-printing', we get:
11962
11963`ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
11964 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11965 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
11966 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11967 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11968 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11969 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11970
11971`ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
11972 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11973 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
11974 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
11975 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
11976 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
11977 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
11978
11979*** Miscellany (subgroup)
11980
11981The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
11982messages should be sent.
11983
11984It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
11985front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
11986`ps-user-defined-prologue'.
11987
11988The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
11989
11990The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
11991points for line numbers.
11992
11993The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
11994numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
11995
11996The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11997line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11998to 2, the printing will look like:
11999
12000 1 one line
12001 one line
12002 3 one line
12003 one line
12004 5 one line
12005 one line
12006 ...
12007
12008Valid values are:
12009
12010integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12011 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12012 is used.
12013
12014`zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12015 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12016
12017Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12018
12019The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12020the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12021`ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
120223, the output will look like:
12023
12024 one line
12025 one line
12026 3 one line
12027 one line
12028 one line
12029 6 one line
12030 one line
12031 one line
12032 9 one line
12033 one line
12034 ...
12035
12036The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12037where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12038
12039The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12040for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12041`ps-font-size').
12042
12043The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12044in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12045`ps-font-size').
12046
12047The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12048
12049The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12050start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
3787e12e
GM
12051
12052** hideshow changes.
12053
12054*** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12055C++, ; for lisp).
12056
12057*** Support for java-mode added.
12058
12059*** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12060in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12061
f3780fe4 12062*** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
3787e12e
GM
12063the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12064way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12065
12066*** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12067robust and a lot faster.
12068
12069*** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12070
12071*** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12072to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12073documentation for more details.
12074
12075** Changes in Enriched mode.
12076
12077*** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12078filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12079of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12080use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12081the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12082
12083*** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12084distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12085as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12086as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12087
12088** Font Lock mode
12089
12090*** Custom support
12091
12092The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12093font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12094faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12095group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12096your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12097consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12098
12099You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12100
12101*** Maximum decoration
12102
12103Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12104default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12105of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12106supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12107to get the old behavior.
12108
12109*** New support
12110
12111Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12112
12113Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12114support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12115
12116*** Configurable support
12117
12118Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12119additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12120c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12121java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12122list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12123of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12124convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12125
12126Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12127way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12128it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12129
12130*** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12131
12132You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12133highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12134for any mode.
12135
12136For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12137
12138 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12139
12140in your ~/.emacs.
12141
12142*** New faces
12143
12144Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12145font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12146distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12147to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12148
12149*** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12150
12151The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12152cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12153same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12154
12155*** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12156
12157The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12158according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12159the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12160non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12161refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12162the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
dfd67a62 12163Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
3787e12e
GM
12164
12165This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12166For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12167this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12168refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12169containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12170the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12171
12172As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12173
12174Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12175Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12176Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12177new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12178
12179If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12180settings.
12181
12182** Ada mode changes.
12183
12184*** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12185If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12186procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12187you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12188stubs.
12189
12190*** There are two new commands:
12191 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12192 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12193
12194The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12195`ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12196`ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12197
12198*** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12199is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12200Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12201
12202*** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12203formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12204places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12205space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12206
12207** Scheme mode changes.
12208
12209*** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12210mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12211for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12212with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12213have any effect.
12214
12215If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12216still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12217scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12218variables as buffer-local variables.
12219
12220*** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12221Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12222
12223** Changes to the emacsclient program
12224
12225*** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12226USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12227associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12228can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12229
12230*** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12231it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12232buffer in Emacs.
12233
12234*** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12235use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12236ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12237option takes precedence.
12238
12239** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12240constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12241(in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12242
12243** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12244which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12245the current defun.
12246
12247** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12248following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12249
12250** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12251and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12252necessary).
12253
12254** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12255if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12256these register values no longer become completely useless.
12257If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12258asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12259it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12260
12261** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12262example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12263be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12264you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12265
12266You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12267variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12268file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12269revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12270only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12271
12272** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12273since it applies only to the current frame.
12274
12275** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12276file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12277and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12278
12279This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12280multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12281variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12282tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12283instead of just the file you are editing.
12284
12285** RefTeX mode
12286
12287RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12288and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12289different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12290multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12291turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12292
12293C-c ( reftex-label
12294 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12295 knows which kind of label is needed.
12296
12297C-c ) reftex-reference
12298 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12299 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12300
12301C-c [ reftex-citation
12302 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12303 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12304
12305C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12306 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12307
12308C-c = reftex-toc
12309 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12310 can quickly jump to every section.
12311
12312Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12313commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12314Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12315reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12316C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12317
12318** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12319
12320*** Info documentation is now available.
12321
12322*** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12323both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12324
12325*** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12326bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12327
12328*** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12329(use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12330
12331*** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12332entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12333appropriate functions.
12334
12335*** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
3a426197 12336entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
3787e12e
GM
12337
12338*** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12339been cleaned.
12340
12341*** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12342bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12343
12344*** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12345shall be delimited.
12346
12347*** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12348bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12349bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12350
12351*** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12352field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12353prefixed with `ALT'.
12354
12355*** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12356bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12357formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12358documentation).
12359
12360*** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12361documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12362for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12363
12364*** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12365comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12366
12367*** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12368alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12369signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12370
12371*** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12372
12373*** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12374
12375*** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12376from alien sources.
12377
12378*** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12379to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12380crossref entries.
12381
12382*** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12383region.
12384
12385*** Added support for imenu.
12386
12387*** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12388of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12389`compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12390`next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12391
12392*** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12393from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12394
12395** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12396
12397** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12398
12399** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12400functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12401Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12402as an argument.
12403
12404When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12405and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12406
12407** browse-url changes
12408
12409*** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12410Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12411(browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12412non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12413customization variables.
12414
12415*** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12416
12417*** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12418lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12419(e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12420
12421** Changes in Ediff
12422
12423*** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12424pops up the Info file for this command.
12425
12426*** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12427the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12428merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12429directories).
12430
12431*** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12432and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12433files in the same directory.
12434
12435*** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12436The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12437related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12438
12439** Changes in Viper
12440
12441*** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12442*** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12443 instead of vip-.
12444*** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12445*** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12446Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12447*** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12448*** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12449*** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12450color when Viper is in insert state.
12451*** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12452Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12453viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12454
12455** Etags changes.
12456
12457*** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12458default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12459Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12460variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12461not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12462
12463*** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12464
12465*** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12466constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12467
12468*** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12469recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12470In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12471
12472*** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12473C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12474recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12475methods and protocols.
12476
12477*** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12478.cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12479column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12480paragraph name.
12481
12482*** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12483an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12484at least M times and as many as N times.
12485
12486** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12487in files has changed slightly.
12488
12489With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12490time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12491This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12492with old time-stamp-format values.
12493
12494In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12495(`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12496This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12497reasons.
12498
12499In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12500natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12501fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12502(`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12503time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12504specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12505
12506Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12507case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12508truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12509
12510The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12511being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12512future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12513recommended now will continue to work then.
12514
12515See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12516details.
12517
12518** There are some additional major modes:
12519
12520dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12521m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12522meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12523
12524** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12525copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12526into Emacs.
12527
12528** New Lisp packages include:
12529
12530*** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12531
12532*** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12533be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12534
12535*** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12536
12537*** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12538in shell buffers.
12539
12540*** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12541See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12542and `elint-defun'.
12543
12544*** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12545meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12546ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12547strings or comments.
12548
12549These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12550abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12551you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12552insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12553at these points.
12554
12555*** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12556can visit them by short forms of their names.
12557
12558*** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12559Emacs Lisp function at point.
12560
12561*** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12562
12563*** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12564switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12565
12566*** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12567
12568*** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12569
12570*** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12571
12572*** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12573from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12574
12575*** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12576You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12577inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12578original place after inserting the copy.
12579
12580*** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12581on the buffer.
12582
12583You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12584velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12585(with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12586
12587Enable mouse-drag with:
12588 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12589-or-
12590 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12591
12592*** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12593mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12594
12595*** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12596It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12597
12598*** ogonek
12599
12600The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12601Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12602platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12603TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12604ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12605prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12606instance) and vice versa.
12607
12608To use this package load it using
12609 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12610Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12611 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12612 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12613The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12614ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12615
12616*** Interface to ph.
12617
12618Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12619
12620The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12621services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12622these servers.
12623
12624*** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
12625
12626*** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
12627You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
12628while the real cursor does not move.
12629
12630*** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
12631for visiting your favorite web sites.
12632
12633*** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
12634so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
12635
12636** movemail change
12637
12638Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
12639mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
12640supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
12641user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
12642
12643This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
05197f40 12644\f
3787e12e
GM
12645* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
12646
12647** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
12648
12649Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
12650end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
12651Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
12652file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
12653file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
12654
12655To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
12656C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
12657coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
12658specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
12659LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
12660save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
05197f40 12661\f
3787e12e
GM
12662* Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
12663
12664** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
12665Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
12666vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
12667Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
12668
12669** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
12670to start with w32- instead of win32-.
12671
12672In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
12673don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
12674"win".
12675
12676** Basic Lisp changes
12677
12678*** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
12679evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
12680
12681*** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
12682be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
12683or by the user.
12684
12685The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
12686
12687*** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
12688
12689(when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
12690(unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
12691
12692*** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
12693usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
12694its argument.
12695
12696*** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
12697
12698*** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
12699
12700*** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12701
12702*** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12703error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12704include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12705`format' function.
12706
12707*** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12708or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12709whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12710
12711*** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12712either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12713adding one of these suffixes.
12714
12715*** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12716which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12717If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12718
12719We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12720because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12721
12722*** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12723
12724*** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12725You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12726
12727*** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12728conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12729
12730 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12731
12732BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12733BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12734
12735*** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12736choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12737restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12738works using `save-current-buffer'.
12739
12740*** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12741write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12742of the last form.
12743
12744*** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12745which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12746last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12747as the last form.
12748
12749*** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12750characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12751matches.
12752
12753For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12754
12755*** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12756with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12757Then it returns that string.
12758
12759For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
12760
12761(with-output-to-string
12762 (princ "The buffer is ")
12763 (princ (buffer-name)))
12764
12765returns "The buffer is foo".
12766
12767** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
12768is non-nil.
12769
12770These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
12771buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
12772characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
12773
12774*** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
12775a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
12776
12777Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
12778character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
12779Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
12780position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
12781characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
12782 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
12783
12784ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
12785Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
12786non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
12787characters".
12788
12789The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
12790through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
12791"leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
12792range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
12793leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
12794
12795*** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
12796(forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
12797multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
12798character, which may be more than one buffer position.
12799
12800This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
12801always one buffer position, need to be changed.
12802
12803However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
12804
12805*** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
12806because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
12807have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
12808the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
12809guaranteed.
12810
12811*** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
12812between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
12813character).
12814
12815When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
12816
12817 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
12818 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
12819 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
12820 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
12821 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
12822
12823*** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
12824
12825*** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
12826`length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
12827more than the number of characters.
12828
12829You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
12830it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
12831\xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
12832is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
12833follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
12834newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
12835
12836*** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
12837and returns a string containing those characters.
12838
12839*** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
12840(sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
12841counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
12842character, sref signals an error.
12843
12844*** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
12845in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
12846string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12847
12848*** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
12849in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
12850region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12851
12852*** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
12853the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
12854to a vector of the characters in it.
12855
12856*** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
12857of a string. You call it as follows:
12858
12859 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
12860
12861This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
12862STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
12863This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
12864Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
12865it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
12866
12867*** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
12868if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12869
12870*** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
12871if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12872
12873*** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
12874to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
12875not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
12876which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
12877
12878(truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
12879
12880This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
12881
12882The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
12883If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
12884are not included in the resulting value.
12885
12886The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
12887at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
12888WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
12889is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
12890
12891If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
12892place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
12893character extends across that column), then the padding character
12894PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
12895string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
12896column START-COLUMN.
12897
12898*** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
12899the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
12900necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
12901difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
12902changed text, before the change.
12903
12904*** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
12905sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
12906one character set for each script, not for each language.
12907
12908**** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
12909
12910**** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
12911
12912**** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
12913set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
12914
12915**** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
12916name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
12917which identify the character within that character set.
12918
12919**** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
12920byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
12921opposite of split-char.
12922
12923**** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
12924of all the characters between BEG and END.
12925
12926**** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
12927of all the characters in a string.
12928
12929*** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
12930and specifying coding systems.
12931
12932**** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
12933system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
12934of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
12935(Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
12936and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
12937as what to do about code conversion.)
12938
12939**** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
12940name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
12941
12942**** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12943for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12944except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
12945
12946Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12947which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
12948to match against a file name.
12949
12950VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12951a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12952decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12953to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12954systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12955specifies the coding system for encoding.
12956
12957If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12958or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12959
12960**** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
12961the coding system to use for network sockets.
12962
12963Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12964which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
12965either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
12966service names.
12967
12968VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12969a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12970decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12971to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12972systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12973specifies the coding system for encoding.
12974
12975If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12976or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12977
12978**** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12979for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12980except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
12981start the subprocess.
12982
12983**** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
12984systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
12985when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
12986(OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
12987to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
12988
12989**** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
12990coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
12991subprocess.
12992
12993It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
12994but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
12995start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12996connection permanently or until overridden.
12997
12998The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12999file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13000network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13001coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13002It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13003system for one operation at a time.
13004
13005**** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13006files, subprocesses or network connections.
13007
13008**** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13009coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13010The value is a cons cell,
13011 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13012where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13013the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13014input to the subprocess.
13015
13016**** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13017change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13018
13019** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13020customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13021you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13022
13023You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13024variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13025information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13026legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13027customization.
13028
13029Thus, instead of writing
13030
13031 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13032 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13033
13034you would now write this:
13035
13036 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13037 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13038 :type 'boolean
13039 :group foo)
13040
13041The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13042two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13043describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13044for a description of them.
13045
13046The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13047should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13048
13049 (defgroup ispell nil
13050 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13051 :group 'processes)
13052
13053The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13054group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13055but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13056to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13057second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13058
13059Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13060package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13061have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13062package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13063first-level subgroups.
13064
13065** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13066
13067This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13068separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13069
13070** easy-mmode
13071
13072The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13073developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13074only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13075predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13076`easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13077`easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13078
13079** Text property changes
13080
13081*** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13082text property.
13083
13084*** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13085previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13086place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13087functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13088starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13089
13090If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13091LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13092of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13093position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13094
13095*** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13096value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13097is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13098
13099** Changes in invisibility features
13100
13101*** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13102hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13103is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13104should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13105would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13106make the overlay visible.
13107
13108During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13109invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13110needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13111which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13112the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13113t when it should hide it.
13114
13115*** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13116
13117Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13118invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13119and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13120Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13121manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13122Here is an example of how to do this:
13123
13124 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13125 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13126 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13127 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13128
13129 ...
13130 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13131
13132 ...
13133 ;; When done with the overlays:
13134 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13135 ;; Or respectively:
13136 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13137
13138** Changes in syntax parsing.
13139
13140*** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13141`parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13142obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13143`parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13144
13145If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13146is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13147used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13148
13149When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13150character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13151
13152 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13153 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13154
13155 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13156 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13157 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13158
13159 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13160 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13161 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13162 determine the syntax type of the character.
13163
13164 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13165 of the current buffer.
13166
13167*** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13168value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13169for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13170
13171*** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13172and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13173only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13174character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13175another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13176
13177These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13178text property.
13179
13180*** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13181arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13182of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13183
13184*** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13185(and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13186element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13187nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13188string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13189
13190*** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13191syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13192`font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13193
13194** Changes in face features
13195
13196*** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13197if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13198
13199*** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13200of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13201
13202*** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13203set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13204
13205*** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13206set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13207
13208*** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13209by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13210and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13211the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13212overlay property).
13213
13214This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13215arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13216
13217** Changes in file-handling functions
13218
13219*** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13220directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13221they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13222is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13223
13224This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13225begins with ~.
13226
13227*** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13228it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13229
13230*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13231the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13232
13233*** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13234as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13235
13236*** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13237character code conversion as well as other things.
13238
13239Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13240(formerly it did not).
13241
13242*** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13243environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13244
13245*** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13246instead of constant strings.
13247
13248*** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13249to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13250any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13251
13252substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13253in the same way as before.
13254
13255*** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13256The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13257which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13258
13259*** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13260error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13261else, and returns nil.
13262
13263*** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13264directory cannot be listed.
13265
13266** Changes in minibuffer input
13267
13268*** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13269read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13270additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13271argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13272ways:
13273
13274 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13275 It is available through the history command M-n.
13276
13277*** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13278read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13279argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13280minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13281enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13282
13283In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13284argument in this way.
13285
13286*** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13287from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13288minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13289
13290** Echo area features
13291
13292*** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13293echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13294minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13295after the echo area is cleared.
13296
13297*** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13298in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13299
13300** Keyboard input features
13301
13302*** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13303set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13304
13305*** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13306received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13307by keyboard macros.
13308
13309** Frame-related changes
13310
13311*** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13312creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13313hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13314
13315*** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13316the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13317has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13318
13319*** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13320selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13321value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13322in the selected frame.
13323
13324*** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13325is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13326which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13327
13328** X Windows features
13329
13330*** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13331x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13332x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13333
13334*** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13335The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13336
13337*** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13338MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13339A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13340
13341If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13342it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13343
13344** Subprocess features
13345
13346*** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13347functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13348automatically.
13349
13350*** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13351and returns the output from the command as a string.
13352
13353*** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13354and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13355
13356** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13357does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13358
13359** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13360at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13361goes after the other menu items.
13362
13363** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13364of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13365around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13366are in use.
13367
13368The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13369series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13370
13371Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13372after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13373form.
13374
13375** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13376is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13377but its hook is still run.
13378
13379** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13380for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13381
13382If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13383regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13384useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13385
13386This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13387are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13388filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13389warned.
13390
13391** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13392way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13393
13394** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13395integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13396functions like display-time.
13397
13398** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13399name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13400
13401** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13402can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13403is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13404
13405** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13406if there is an error in compilation.
13407
13408** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13409switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13410argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13411they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13412
13413** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13414Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13415the *scratch* buffer.
13416
13417** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13418The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13419where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13420e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13421
13422** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13423and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13424It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13425
13426** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13427using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13428variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13429and compose-mail-other-frame.
13430
13431** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13432can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13433full name of the specified user will be returned.
13434
13435** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13436of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13437where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13438in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13439option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13440files at all.
13441
13442** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13443and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13444width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13445the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13446
13447For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13448minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13449with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13450is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13451
13452** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13453
13454** imenu.el changes.
13455
13456You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13457item from menu created by imenu.
13458
13459An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13460#include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13461select one of those items.
05197f40 13462\f
3787e12e 13463* For older news, see the file ONEWS
a933dad1
DL
13464
13465----------------------------------------------------------------------
13466Copyright information:
13467
175573ac 13468Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
13469
13470 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13471 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13472 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13473 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13474
13475 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13476 of this document, or of portions of it,
13477 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13478 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
05197f40 13479\f
a933dad1
DL
13480Local variables:
13481mode: outline
13482paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13483end:
ab5796a9
MB
13484
13485arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793